blob: 455730c909bbd3925de839d9c6aef391d58ddd08 [file] [log] [blame]
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +00001//===--- SemaExpr.cpp - Semantic Analysis for Expressions -----------------===//
2//
3// The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure
4//
Chris Lattner5b12ab82007-12-29 19:59:25 +00005// This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source
6// License. See LICENSE.TXT for details.
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +00007//
8//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
9//
10// This file implements semantic analysis for expressions.
11//
12//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
13
John McCall83024632010-08-25 22:03:47 +000014#include "clang/Sema/SemaInternal.h"
Douglas Gregorc3a6ade2010-08-12 20:07:10 +000015#include "clang/Sema/Initialization.h"
16#include "clang/Sema/Lookup.h"
17#include "clang/Sema/AnalysisBasedWarnings.h"
Chris Lattnercb6a3822006-11-10 06:20:45 +000018#include "clang/AST/ASTContext.h"
Douglas Gregord1702062010-04-29 00:18:15 +000019#include "clang/AST/CXXInheritance.h"
Daniel Dunbar6e8aa532008-08-11 05:35:13 +000020#include "clang/AST/DeclObjC.h"
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +000021#include "clang/AST/DeclTemplate.h"
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +000022#include "clang/AST/Expr.h"
Chris Lattneraa9c7ae2008-04-08 04:40:51 +000023#include "clang/AST/ExprCXX.h"
Steve Naroff021ca182008-05-29 21:12:08 +000024#include "clang/AST/ExprObjC.h"
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +000025#include "clang/AST/RecursiveASTVisitor.h"
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +000026#include "clang/AST/TypeLoc.h"
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +000027#include "clang/Basic/PartialDiagnostic.h"
Steve Narofff2fb89e2007-03-13 20:29:44 +000028#include "clang/Basic/SourceManager.h"
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +000029#include "clang/Basic/TargetInfo.h"
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +000030#include "clang/Lex/LiteralSupport.h"
31#include "clang/Lex/Preprocessor.h"
John McCall8b0666c2010-08-20 18:27:03 +000032#include "clang/Sema/DeclSpec.h"
33#include "clang/Sema/Designator.h"
34#include "clang/Sema/Scope.h"
John McCallaab3e412010-08-25 08:40:02 +000035#include "clang/Sema/ScopeInfo.h"
John McCall8b0666c2010-08-20 18:27:03 +000036#include "clang/Sema/ParsedTemplate.h"
John McCallde6836a2010-08-24 07:21:54 +000037#include "clang/Sema/Template.h"
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +000038using namespace clang;
John McCallaab3e412010-08-25 08:40:02 +000039using namespace sema;
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +000040
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +000041
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000042/// \brief Determine whether the use of this declaration is valid, and
43/// emit any corresponding diagnostics.
44///
45/// This routine diagnoses various problems with referencing
46/// declarations that can occur when using a declaration. For example,
47/// it might warn if a deprecated or unavailable declaration is being
48/// used, or produce an error (and return true) if a C++0x deleted
49/// function is being used.
50///
Chris Lattnerb7df3c62009-10-25 22:31:57 +000051/// If IgnoreDeprecated is set to true, this should not want about deprecated
52/// decls.
53///
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000054/// \returns true if there was an error (this declaration cannot be
55/// referenced), false otherwise.
Chris Lattnerb7df3c62009-10-25 22:31:57 +000056///
John McCall28a6aea2009-11-04 02:18:39 +000057bool Sema::DiagnoseUseOfDecl(NamedDecl *D, SourceLocation Loc) {
Chris Lattner4bf74fd2009-02-15 22:43:40 +000058 // See if the decl is deprecated.
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb4b64ca2009-06-30 02:34:44 +000059 if (D->getAttr<DeprecatedAttr>()) {
John McCall28a6aea2009-11-04 02:18:39 +000060 EmitDeprecationWarning(D, Loc);
Chris Lattner4bf74fd2009-02-15 22:43:40 +000061 }
62
Chris Lattnera27dd592009-10-25 17:21:40 +000063 // See if the decl is unavailable
64 if (D->getAttr<UnavailableAttr>()) {
Ted Kremenek1ddd6d22010-07-21 20:43:11 +000065 Diag(Loc, diag::err_unavailable) << D->getDeclName();
Chris Lattnera27dd592009-10-25 17:21:40 +000066 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_unavailable_here) << 0;
67 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +000068
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000069 // See if this is a deleted function.
Douglas Gregorde681d42009-02-24 04:26:15 +000070 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000071 if (FD->isDeleted()) {
72 Diag(Loc, diag::err_deleted_function_use);
73 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_unavailable_here) << true;
74 return true;
75 }
Douglas Gregorde681d42009-02-24 04:26:15 +000076 }
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000077
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000078 return false;
Chris Lattner4bf74fd2009-02-15 22:43:40 +000079}
80
Fariborz Jahanian027b8862009-05-13 18:09:35 +000081/// DiagnoseSentinelCalls - This routine checks on method dispatch calls
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000082/// (and other functions in future), which have been declared with sentinel
Fariborz Jahanian027b8862009-05-13 18:09:35 +000083/// attribute. It warns if call does not have the sentinel argument.
84///
85void Sema::DiagnoseSentinelCalls(NamedDecl *D, SourceLocation Loc,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000086 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb4b64ca2009-06-30 02:34:44 +000087 const SentinelAttr *attr = D->getAttr<SentinelAttr>();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000088 if (!attr)
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +000089 return;
Douglas Gregorc298ffc2010-04-22 16:44:27 +000090
91 // FIXME: In C++0x, if any of the arguments are parameter pack
92 // expansions, we can't check for the sentinel now.
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +000093 int sentinelPos = attr->getSentinel();
94 int nullPos = attr->getNullPos();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000095
Mike Stump87c57ac2009-05-16 07:39:55 +000096 // FIXME. ObjCMethodDecl and FunctionDecl need be derived from the same common
97 // base class. Then we won't be needing two versions of the same code.
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +000098 unsigned int i = 0;
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +000099 bool warnNotEnoughArgs = false;
100 int isMethod = 0;
101 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(D)) {
102 // skip over named parameters.
103 ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator P, E = MD->param_end();
104 for (P = MD->param_begin(); (P != E && i < NumArgs); ++P) {
105 if (nullPos)
106 --nullPos;
107 else
108 ++i;
109 }
110 warnNotEnoughArgs = (P != E || i >= NumArgs);
111 isMethod = 1;
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000112 } else if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000113 // skip over named parameters.
114 ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator P, E = FD->param_end();
115 for (P = FD->param_begin(); (P != E && i < NumArgs); ++P) {
116 if (nullPos)
117 --nullPos;
118 else
119 ++i;
120 }
121 warnNotEnoughArgs = (P != E || i >= NumArgs);
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000122 } else if (VarDecl *V = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahanian0aa5c452009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000123 // block or function pointer call.
124 QualType Ty = V->getType();
125 if (Ty->isBlockPointerType() || Ty->isFunctionPointerType()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000126 const FunctionType *FT = Ty->isFunctionPointerType()
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +0000127 ? Ty->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>()
128 : Ty->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>();
Fariborz Jahanian0aa5c452009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000129 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FT)) {
130 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
131 unsigned k;
132 for (k = 0; (k != NumArgsInProto && i < NumArgs); k++) {
133 if (nullPos)
134 --nullPos;
135 else
136 ++i;
137 }
138 warnNotEnoughArgs = (k != NumArgsInProto || i >= NumArgs);
139 }
140 if (Ty->isBlockPointerType())
141 isMethod = 2;
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000142 } else
Fariborz Jahanian0aa5c452009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000143 return;
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000144 } else
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000145 return;
146
147 if (warnNotEnoughArgs) {
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000148 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_enough_argument) << D->getDeclName();
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000149 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000150 return;
151 }
152 int sentinel = i;
153 while (sentinelPos > 0 && i < NumArgs-1) {
154 --sentinelPos;
155 ++i;
156 }
157 if (sentinelPos > 0) {
158 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_enough_argument) << D->getDeclName();
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000159 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000160 return;
161 }
162 while (i < NumArgs-1) {
163 ++i;
164 ++sentinel;
165 }
166 Expr *sentinelExpr = Args[sentinel];
John McCall7ddbcf42010-05-06 23:53:00 +0000167 if (!sentinelExpr) return;
168 if (sentinelExpr->isTypeDependent()) return;
169 if (sentinelExpr->isValueDependent()) return;
Fariborz Jahanianc0b0ced2010-07-14 16:37:51 +0000170 if (sentinelExpr->getType()->isAnyPointerType() &&
John McCall7ddbcf42010-05-06 23:53:00 +0000171 sentinelExpr->IgnoreParenCasts()->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
172 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull))
173 return;
174
175 // Unfortunately, __null has type 'int'.
176 if (isa<GNUNullExpr>(sentinelExpr)) return;
177
178 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_missing_sentinel) << isMethod;
179 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian027b8862009-05-13 18:09:35 +0000180}
181
Douglas Gregor87f95b02009-02-26 21:00:50 +0000182SourceRange Sema::getExprRange(ExprTy *E) const {
183 Expr *Ex = (Expr *)E;
184 return Ex? Ex->getSourceRange() : SourceRange();
185}
186
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000187//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
188// Standard Promotions and Conversions
189//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
190
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000191/// DefaultFunctionArrayConversion (C99 6.3.2.1p3, C99 6.3.2.1p4).
192void Sema::DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(Expr *&E) {
193 QualType Ty = E->getType();
194 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultFunctionArrayConversion - missing type");
195
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000196 if (Ty->isFunctionType())
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000197 ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getPointerType(Ty),
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000198 CK_FunctionToPointerDecay);
Chris Lattner61f60a02008-07-25 21:33:13 +0000199 else if (Ty->isArrayType()) {
200 // In C90 mode, arrays only promote to pointers if the array expression is
201 // an lvalue. The relevant legalese is C90 6.2.2.1p3: "an lvalue that has
202 // type 'array of type' is converted to an expression that has type 'pointer
203 // to type'...". In C99 this was changed to: C99 6.3.2.1p3: "an expression
204 // that has type 'array of type' ...". The relevant change is "an lvalue"
205 // (C90) to "an expression" (C99).
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9321c742008-09-11 04:25:59 +0000206 //
207 // C++ 4.2p1:
208 // An lvalue or rvalue of type "array of N T" or "array of unknown bound of
209 // T" can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to T".
210 //
211 if (getLangOptions().C99 || getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ||
212 E->isLvalue(Context) == Expr::LV_Valid)
Anders Carlsson8fc489d2009-08-07 23:48:20 +0000213 ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getArrayDecayedType(Ty),
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000214 CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Chris Lattner61f60a02008-07-25 21:33:13 +0000215 }
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000216}
217
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000218void Sema::DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Expr *&E) {
219 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(E);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000220
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000221 QualType Ty = E->getType();
222 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion - missing type");
223 if (!Ty->isDependentType() && Ty.hasQualifiers() &&
224 (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus || !Ty->isRecordType()) &&
225 E->isLvalue(Context) == Expr::LV_Valid) {
226 // C++ [conv.lval]p1:
227 // [...] If T is a non-class type, the type of the rvalue is the
228 // cv-unqualified version of T. Otherwise, the type of the
229 // rvalue is T
230 //
231 // C99 6.3.2.1p2:
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000232 // If the lvalue has qualified type, the value has the unqualified
233 // version of the type of the lvalue; otherwise, the value has the
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000234 // type of the lvalue.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000235 ImpCastExprToType(E, Ty.getUnqualifiedType(), CK_NoOp);
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000236 }
237}
238
239
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000240/// UsualUnaryConversions - Performs various conversions that are common to most
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000241/// operators (C99 6.3). The conversions of array and function types are
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000242/// sometimes surpressed. For example, the array->pointer conversion doesn't
243/// apply if the array is an argument to the sizeof or address (&) operators.
244/// In these instances, this routine should *not* be called.
245Expr *Sema::UsualUnaryConversions(Expr *&Expr) {
246 QualType Ty = Expr->getType();
247 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "UsualUnaryConversions - missing type");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000248
Douglas Gregor8d9c5092009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000249 // C99 6.3.1.1p2:
250 //
251 // The following may be used in an expression wherever an int or
252 // unsigned int may be used:
253 // - an object or expression with an integer type whose integer
254 // conversion rank is less than or equal to the rank of int
255 // and unsigned int.
256 // - A bit-field of type _Bool, int, signed int, or unsigned int.
257 //
258 // If an int can represent all values of the original type, the
259 // value is converted to an int; otherwise, it is converted to an
260 // unsigned int. These are called the integer promotions. All
261 // other types are unchanged by the integer promotions.
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000262 QualType PTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(Expr);
263 if (!PTy.isNull()) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000264 ImpCastExprToType(Expr, PTy, CK_IntegralCast);
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000265 return Expr;
266 }
Douglas Gregor8d9c5092009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000267 if (Ty->isPromotableIntegerType()) {
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +0000268 QualType PT = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(Ty);
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000269 ImpCastExprToType(Expr, PT, CK_IntegralCast);
Douglas Gregor8d9c5092009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000270 return Expr;
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000271 }
272
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000273 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Expr);
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000274 return Expr;
275}
276
Chris Lattner2ce500f2008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000277/// DefaultArgumentPromotion (C99 6.5.2.2p6). Used for function calls that
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000278/// do not have a prototype. Arguments that have type float are promoted to
Chris Lattner2ce500f2008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000279/// double. All other argument types are converted by UsualUnaryConversions().
280void Sema::DefaultArgumentPromotion(Expr *&Expr) {
281 QualType Ty = Expr->getType();
282 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultArgumentPromotion - missing type");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000283
Chris Lattner2ce500f2008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000284 // If this is a 'float' (CVR qualified or typedef) promote to double.
Chris Lattnerbb53efb2010-05-16 04:01:30 +0000285 if (Ty->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Float))
286 return ImpCastExprToType(Expr, Context.DoubleTy,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000287 CK_FloatingCast);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000288
Chris Lattner2ce500f2008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000289 UsualUnaryConversions(Expr);
290}
291
Chris Lattnera8a7d0f2009-04-12 08:11:20 +0000292/// DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion - Like DefaultArgumentPromotion, but
293/// will warn if the resulting type is not a POD type, and rejects ObjC
294/// interfaces passed by value. This returns true if the argument type is
295/// completely illegal.
Chris Lattnerbb53efb2010-05-16 04:01:30 +0000296bool Sema::DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Expr *&Expr, VariadicCallType CT,
297 FunctionDecl *FDecl) {
Anders Carlssona7d069d2009-01-16 16:48:51 +0000298 DefaultArgumentPromotion(Expr);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000299
Chris Lattnerbb53efb2010-05-16 04:01:30 +0000300 // __builtin_va_start takes the second argument as a "varargs" argument, but
301 // it doesn't actually do anything with it. It doesn't need to be non-pod
302 // etc.
303 if (FDecl && FDecl->getBuiltinID() == Builtin::BI__builtin_va_start)
304 return false;
305
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +0000306 if (Expr->getType()->isObjCObjectType() &&
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000307 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Expr->getLocStart(),
308 PDiag(diag::err_cannot_pass_objc_interface_to_vararg)
309 << Expr->getType() << CT))
310 return true;
Douglas Gregor7ca84af2009-12-12 07:25:49 +0000311
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000312 if (!Expr->getType()->isPODType() &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000313 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Expr->getLocStart(),
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000314 PDiag(diag::warn_cannot_pass_non_pod_arg_to_vararg)
315 << Expr->getType() << CT))
316 return true;
Chris Lattnera8a7d0f2009-04-12 08:11:20 +0000317
318 return false;
Anders Carlssona7d069d2009-01-16 16:48:51 +0000319}
320
321
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000322/// UsualArithmeticConversions - Performs various conversions that are common to
323/// binary operators (C99 6.3.1.8). If both operands aren't arithmetic, this
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000324/// routine returns the first non-arithmetic type found. The client is
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000325/// responsible for emitting appropriate error diagnostics.
326/// FIXME: verify the conversion rules for "complex int" are consistent with
327/// GCC.
328QualType Sema::UsualArithmeticConversions(Expr *&lhsExpr, Expr *&rhsExpr,
329 bool isCompAssign) {
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000330 if (!isCompAssign)
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000331 UsualUnaryConversions(lhsExpr);
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000332
333 UsualUnaryConversions(rhsExpr);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000334
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000335 // For conversion purposes, we ignore any qualifiers.
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000336 // For example, "const float" and "float" are equivalent.
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +0000337 QualType lhs =
338 Context.getCanonicalType(lhsExpr->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000339 QualType rhs =
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +0000340 Context.getCanonicalType(rhsExpr->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000341
342 // If both types are identical, no conversion is needed.
343 if (lhs == rhs)
344 return lhs;
345
346 // If either side is a non-arithmetic type (e.g. a pointer), we are done.
347 // The caller can deal with this (e.g. pointer + int).
348 if (!lhs->isArithmeticType() || !rhs->isArithmeticType())
349 return lhs;
350
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000351 // Perform bitfield promotions.
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000352 QualType LHSBitfieldPromoteTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lhsExpr);
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000353 if (!LHSBitfieldPromoteTy.isNull())
354 lhs = LHSBitfieldPromoteTy;
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000355 QualType RHSBitfieldPromoteTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(rhsExpr);
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000356 if (!RHSBitfieldPromoteTy.isNull())
357 rhs = RHSBitfieldPromoteTy;
358
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +0000359 QualType destType = Context.UsualArithmeticConversionsType(lhs, rhs);
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000360 if (!isCompAssign)
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000361 ImpCastExprToType(lhsExpr, destType, CK_Unknown);
362 ImpCastExprToType(rhsExpr, destType, CK_Unknown);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000363 return destType;
364}
365
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000366//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
367// Semantic Analysis for various Expression Types
368//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
369
370
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +0000371/// ActOnStringLiteral - The specified tokens were lexed as pasted string
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000372/// fragments (e.g. "foo" "bar" L"baz"). The result string has to handle string
373/// concatenation ([C99 5.1.1.2, translation phase #6]), so it may come from
374/// multiple tokens. However, the common case is that StringToks points to one
375/// string.
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000376///
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +0000377ExprResult
Alexis Hunt3b791862010-08-30 17:47:05 +0000378Sema::ActOnStringLiteral(const Token *StringToks, unsigned NumStringToks) {
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000379 assert(NumStringToks && "Must have at least one string!");
380
Chris Lattner8a24e582009-01-16 18:51:42 +0000381 StringLiteralParser Literal(StringToks, NumStringToks, PP);
Steve Naroff4f88b312007-03-13 22:37:02 +0000382 if (Literal.hadError)
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000383 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000384
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +0000385 llvm::SmallVector<SourceLocation, 4> StringTokLocs;
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000386 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumStringToks; ++i)
387 StringTokLocs.push_back(StringToks[i].getLocation());
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000388
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000389 QualType StrTy = Context.CharTy;
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscbad7252008-08-09 17:20:01 +0000390 if (Literal.AnyWide) StrTy = Context.getWCharType();
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000391 if (Literal.Pascal) StrTy = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Douglas Gregoraa1e21d2008-09-12 00:47:35 +0000392
393 // A C++ string literal has a const-qualified element type (C++ 2.13.4p1).
Chris Lattnera8687ae2010-06-15 18:05:34 +0000394 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus || getLangOptions().ConstStrings)
Douglas Gregoraa1e21d2008-09-12 00:47:35 +0000395 StrTy.addConst();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000396
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000397 // Get an array type for the string, according to C99 6.4.5. This includes
398 // the nul terminator character as well as the string length for pascal
399 // strings.
400 StrTy = Context.getConstantArrayType(StrTy,
Chris Lattnerd42c29f2009-02-26 23:01:51 +0000401 llvm::APInt(32, Literal.GetNumStringChars()+1),
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000402 ArrayType::Normal, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000403
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000404 // Pass &StringTokLocs[0], StringTokLocs.size() to factory!
Alexis Hunt3b791862010-08-30 17:47:05 +0000405 return Owned(StringLiteral::Create(Context, Literal.GetString(),
406 Literal.GetStringLength(),
407 Literal.AnyWide, StrTy,
408 &StringTokLocs[0],
409 StringTokLocs.size()));
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000410}
411
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000412/// ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference - Return true if a reference inside of
413/// CurBlock to VD should cause it to be snapshotted (as we do for auto
414/// variables defined outside the block) or false if this is not needed (e.g.
415/// for values inside the block or for globals).
416///
Douglas Gregor4f13beb2010-03-01 20:44:28 +0000417/// This also keeps the 'hasBlockDeclRefExprs' in the BlockScopeInfo records
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000418/// up-to-date.
419///
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000420static bool ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference(Sema &S, BlockScopeInfo *CurBlock,
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000421 ValueDecl *VD) {
422 // If the value is defined inside the block, we couldn't snapshot it even if
423 // we wanted to.
424 if (CurBlock->TheDecl == VD->getDeclContext())
425 return false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000426
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000427 // If this is an enum constant or function, it is constant, don't snapshot.
428 if (isa<EnumConstantDecl>(VD) || isa<FunctionDecl>(VD))
429 return false;
430
431 // If this is a reference to an extern, static, or global variable, no need to
432 // snapshot it.
433 // FIXME: What about 'const' variables in C++?
434 if (const VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(VD))
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000435 if (!Var->hasLocalStorage())
436 return false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000437
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000438 // Blocks that have these can't be constant.
439 CurBlock->hasBlockDeclRefExprs = true;
440
441 // If we have nested blocks, the decl may be declared in an outer block (in
442 // which case that outer block doesn't get "hasBlockDeclRefExprs") or it may
443 // be defined outside all of the current blocks (in which case the blocks do
444 // all get the bit). Walk the nesting chain.
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000445 for (unsigned I = S.FunctionScopes.size() - 1; I; --I) {
446 BlockScopeInfo *NextBlock = dyn_cast<BlockScopeInfo>(S.FunctionScopes[I]);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000447
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000448 if (!NextBlock)
449 continue;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000450
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000451 // If we found the defining block for the variable, don't mark the block as
452 // having a reference outside it.
453 if (NextBlock->TheDecl == VD->getDeclContext())
454 break;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000455
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000456 // Otherwise, the DeclRef from the inner block causes the outer one to need
457 // a snapshot as well.
458 NextBlock->hasBlockDeclRefExprs = true;
459 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000460
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000461 return true;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000462}
463
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000464
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +0000465ExprResult
John McCallce546572009-12-08 09:08:17 +0000466Sema::BuildDeclRefExpr(ValueDecl *D, QualType Ty, SourceLocation Loc,
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +0000467 const CXXScopeSpec *SS) {
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000468 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo(D->getDeclName(), Loc);
469 return BuildDeclRefExpr(D, Ty, NameInfo, SS);
470}
471
472/// BuildDeclRefExpr - Build a DeclRefExpr.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +0000473ExprResult
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000474Sema::BuildDeclRefExpr(ValueDecl *D, QualType Ty,
475 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
476 const CXXScopeSpec *SS) {
Anders Carlsson364035d12009-06-26 19:16:07 +0000477 if (Context.getCanonicalType(Ty) == Context.UndeducedAutoTy) {
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000478 Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(),
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000479 diag::err_auto_variable_cannot_appear_in_own_initializer)
Anders Carlsson364035d12009-06-26 19:16:07 +0000480 << D->getDeclName();
481 return ExprError();
482 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000483
Anders Carlsson946b86d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000484 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregor15243332010-04-27 21:10:04 +0000485 if (isa<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(VD)) {
486 // Non-type template parameters can be referenced anywhere they are
487 // visible.
Douglas Gregora8a089b2010-07-13 18:40:04 +0000488 Ty = Ty.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
Douglas Gregor15243332010-04-27 21:10:04 +0000489 } else if (const CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(CurContext)) {
Anders Carlsson946b86d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000490 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = MD->getParent()->isLocalClass()) {
491 if (VD->hasLocalStorage() && VD->getDeclContext() != CurContext) {
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000492 Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(),
493 diag::err_reference_to_local_var_in_enclosing_function)
Anders Carlsson946b86d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000494 << D->getIdentifier() << FD->getDeclName();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000495 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_local_variable_declared_here)
Anders Carlsson946b86d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000496 << D->getIdentifier();
497 return ExprError();
498 }
499 }
500 }
501 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000502
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000503 MarkDeclarationReferenced(NameInfo.getLoc(), D);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000504
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000505 return Owned(DeclRefExpr::Create(Context,
506 SS? (NestedNameSpecifier *)SS->getScopeRep() : 0,
507 SS? SS->getRange() : SourceRange(),
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000508 D, NameInfo, Ty));
Douglas Gregorc7acfdf2009-01-06 05:10:23 +0000509}
510
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000511/// \brief Given a field that represents a member of an anonymous
512/// struct/union, build the path from that field's context to the
513/// actual member.
514///
515/// Construct the sequence of field member references we'll have to
516/// perform to get to the field in the anonymous union/struct. The
517/// list of members is built from the field outward, so traverse it
518/// backwards to go from an object in the current context to the field
519/// we found.
520///
521/// \returns The variable from which the field access should begin,
522/// for an anonymous struct/union that is not a member of another
523/// class. Otherwise, returns NULL.
524VarDecl *Sema::BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(FieldDecl *Field,
525 llvm::SmallVectorImpl<FieldDecl *> &Path) {
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000526 assert(Field->getDeclContext()->isRecord() &&
527 cast<RecordDecl>(Field->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion()
528 && "Field must be stored inside an anonymous struct or union");
529
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000530 Path.push_back(Field);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000531 VarDecl *BaseObject = 0;
532 DeclContext *Ctx = Field->getDeclContext();
533 do {
534 RecordDecl *Record = cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx);
John McCall61925b02010-05-21 01:17:40 +0000535 ValueDecl *AnonObject = Record->getAnonymousStructOrUnionObject();
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000536 if (FieldDecl *AnonField = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(AnonObject))
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000537 Path.push_back(AnonField);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000538 else {
539 BaseObject = cast<VarDecl>(AnonObject);
540 break;
541 }
542 Ctx = Ctx->getParent();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000543 } while (Ctx->isRecord() &&
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000544 cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx)->isAnonymousStructOrUnion());
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000545
546 return BaseObject;
547}
548
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +0000549ExprResult
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000550Sema::BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(SourceLocation Loc,
551 FieldDecl *Field,
552 Expr *BaseObjectExpr,
553 SourceLocation OpLoc) {
554 llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl *, 4> AnonFields;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000555 VarDecl *BaseObject = BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(Field,
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000556 AnonFields);
557
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000558 // Build the expression that refers to the base object, from
559 // which we will build a sequence of member references to each
560 // of the anonymous union objects and, eventually, the field we
561 // found via name lookup.
562 bool BaseObjectIsPointer = false;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000563 Qualifiers BaseQuals;
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000564 if (BaseObject) {
565 // BaseObject is an anonymous struct/union variable (and is,
566 // therefore, not part of another non-anonymous record).
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +0000567 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, BaseObject);
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +0000568 BaseObjectExpr = new (Context) DeclRefExpr(BaseObject,BaseObject->getType(),
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +0000569 SourceLocation());
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000570 BaseQuals
571 = Context.getCanonicalType(BaseObject->getType()).getQualifiers();
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000572 } else if (BaseObjectExpr) {
573 // The caller provided the base object expression. Determine
574 // whether its a pointer and whether it adds any qualifiers to the
575 // anonymous struct/union fields we're looking into.
576 QualType ObjectType = BaseObjectExpr->getType();
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +0000577 if (const PointerType *ObjectPtr = ObjectType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000578 BaseObjectIsPointer = true;
579 ObjectType = ObjectPtr->getPointeeType();
580 }
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000581 BaseQuals
582 = Context.getCanonicalType(ObjectType).getQualifiers();
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000583 } else {
584 // We've found a member of an anonymous struct/union that is
585 // inside a non-anonymous struct/union, so in a well-formed
586 // program our base object expression is "this".
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000587 DeclContext *DC = getFunctionLevelDeclContext();
588 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)) {
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000589 if (!MD->isStatic()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000590 QualType AnonFieldType
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000591 = Context.getTagDeclType(
592 cast<RecordDecl>(AnonFields.back()->getDeclContext()));
593 QualType ThisType = Context.getTagDeclType(MD->getParent());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000594 if ((Context.getCanonicalType(AnonFieldType)
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000595 == Context.getCanonicalType(ThisType)) ||
596 IsDerivedFrom(ThisType, AnonFieldType)) {
597 // Our base object expression is "this".
Douglas Gregor4b654412009-12-24 20:23:34 +0000598 BaseObjectExpr = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc,
Douglas Gregorb15af892010-01-07 23:12:05 +0000599 MD->getThisType(Context),
600 /*isImplicit=*/true);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000601 BaseObjectIsPointer = true;
602 }
603 } else {
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000604 return ExprError(Diag(Loc,diag::err_invalid_member_use_in_static_method)
605 << Field->getDeclName());
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000606 }
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000607 BaseQuals = Qualifiers::fromCVRMask(MD->getTypeQualifiers());
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000608 }
609
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000610 if (!BaseObjectExpr)
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000611 return ExprError(Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_non_static_member_use)
612 << Field->getDeclName());
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000613 }
614
615 // Build the implicit member references to the field of the
616 // anonymous struct/union.
617 Expr *Result = BaseObjectExpr;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000618 Qualifiers ResultQuals = BaseQuals;
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000619 for (llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl *, 4>::reverse_iterator
620 FI = AnonFields.rbegin(), FIEnd = AnonFields.rend();
621 FI != FIEnd; ++FI) {
622 QualType MemberType = (*FI)->getType();
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000623 Qualifiers MemberTypeQuals =
624 Context.getCanonicalType(MemberType).getQualifiers();
625
626 // CVR attributes from the base are picked up by members,
627 // except that 'mutable' members don't pick up 'const'.
628 if ((*FI)->isMutable())
629 ResultQuals.removeConst();
630
631 // GC attributes are never picked up by members.
632 ResultQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
633
634 // TR 18037 does not allow fields to be declared with address spaces.
635 assert(!MemberTypeQuals.hasAddressSpace());
636
637 Qualifiers NewQuals = ResultQuals + MemberTypeQuals;
638 if (NewQuals != MemberTypeQuals)
639 MemberType = Context.getQualifiedType(MemberType, NewQuals);
640
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +0000641 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, *FI);
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +0000642 PerformObjectMemberConversion(Result, /*FIXME:Qualifier=*/0, *FI, *FI);
Douglas Gregorc1905232009-08-26 22:36:53 +0000643 // FIXME: Might this end up being a qualified name?
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +0000644 Result = new (Context) MemberExpr(Result, BaseObjectIsPointer, *FI,
645 OpLoc, MemberType);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000646 BaseObjectIsPointer = false;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000647 ResultQuals = NewQuals;
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000648 }
649
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000650 return Owned(Result);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000651}
652
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000653/// Decomposes the given name into a DeclarationNameInfo, its location, and
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000654/// possibly a list of template arguments.
655///
656/// If this produces template arguments, it is permitted to call
657/// DecomposeTemplateName.
658///
659/// This actually loses a lot of source location information for
660/// non-standard name kinds; we should consider preserving that in
661/// some way.
662static void DecomposeUnqualifiedId(Sema &SemaRef,
663 const UnqualifiedId &Id,
664 TemplateArgumentListInfo &Buffer,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000665 DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000666 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *&TemplateArgs) {
667 if (Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedId::IK_TemplateId) {
668 Buffer.setLAngleLoc(Id.TemplateId->LAngleLoc);
669 Buffer.setRAngleLoc(Id.TemplateId->RAngleLoc);
670
671 ASTTemplateArgsPtr TemplateArgsPtr(SemaRef,
672 Id.TemplateId->getTemplateArgs(),
673 Id.TemplateId->NumArgs);
674 SemaRef.translateTemplateArguments(TemplateArgsPtr, Buffer);
675 TemplateArgsPtr.release();
676
John McCall3e56fd42010-08-23 07:28:44 +0000677 TemplateName TName = Id.TemplateId->Template.get();
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000678 SourceLocation TNameLoc = Id.TemplateId->TemplateNameLoc;
679 NameInfo = SemaRef.Context.getNameForTemplate(TName, TNameLoc);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000680 TemplateArgs = &Buffer;
681 } else {
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000682 NameInfo = SemaRef.GetNameFromUnqualifiedId(Id);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000683 TemplateArgs = 0;
684 }
685}
686
John McCall69f9dbc2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000687/// Determines whether the given record is "fully-formed" at the given
688/// location, i.e. whether a qualified lookup into it is assured of
689/// getting consistent results already.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000690static bool IsFullyFormedScope(Sema &SemaRef, CXXRecordDecl *Record) {
John McCall69f9dbc2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000691 if (!Record->hasDefinition())
692 return false;
693
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000694 for (CXXRecordDecl::base_class_iterator I = Record->bases_begin(),
695 E = Record->bases_end(); I != E; ++I) {
696 CanQualType BaseT = SemaRef.Context.getCanonicalType((*I).getType());
697 CanQual<RecordType> BaseRT = BaseT->getAs<RecordType>();
698 if (!BaseRT) return false;
699
700 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCall69f9dbc2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000701 if (!BaseRecord->hasDefinition() ||
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000702 !IsFullyFormedScope(SemaRef, BaseRecord))
703 return false;
704 }
705
706 return true;
707}
708
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000709/// Determines if the given class is provably not derived from all of
710/// the prospective base classes.
711static bool IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(Sema &SemaRef,
712 CXXRecordDecl *Record,
713 const llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*, 4> &Bases) {
John McCalla6d407c2009-12-01 22:28:41 +0000714 if (Bases.count(Record->getCanonicalDecl()))
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000715 return false;
716
Douglas Gregor0a5a2212010-02-11 01:04:33 +0000717 RecordDecl *RD = Record->getDefinition();
John McCalla6d407c2009-12-01 22:28:41 +0000718 if (!RD) return false;
719 Record = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD);
720
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000721 for (CXXRecordDecl::base_class_iterator I = Record->bases_begin(),
722 E = Record->bases_end(); I != E; ++I) {
723 CanQualType BaseT = SemaRef.Context.getCanonicalType((*I).getType());
724 CanQual<RecordType> BaseRT = BaseT->getAs<RecordType>();
725 if (!BaseRT) return false;
726
727 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000728 if (!IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(SemaRef, BaseRecord, Bases))
729 return false;
730 }
731
732 return true;
733}
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000734
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000735enum IMAKind {
736 /// The reference is definitely not an instance member access.
737 IMA_Static,
738
739 /// The reference may be an implicit instance member access.
740 IMA_Mixed,
741
742 /// The reference may be to an instance member, but it is invalid if
743 /// so, because the context is not an instance method.
744 IMA_Mixed_StaticContext,
745
746 /// The reference may be to an instance member, but it is invalid if
747 /// so, because the context is from an unrelated class.
748 IMA_Mixed_Unrelated,
749
750 /// The reference is definitely an implicit instance member access.
751 IMA_Instance,
752
753 /// The reference may be to an unresolved using declaration.
754 IMA_Unresolved,
755
756 /// The reference may be to an unresolved using declaration and the
757 /// context is not an instance method.
758 IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext,
759
760 /// The reference is to a member of an anonymous structure in a
761 /// non-class context.
762 IMA_AnonymousMember,
763
764 /// All possible referrents are instance members and the current
765 /// context is not an instance method.
766 IMA_Error_StaticContext,
767
768 /// All possible referrents are instance members of an unrelated
769 /// class.
770 IMA_Error_Unrelated
771};
772
773/// The given lookup names class member(s) and is not being used for
774/// an address-of-member expression. Classify the type of access
775/// according to whether it's possible that this reference names an
776/// instance member. This is best-effort; it is okay to
777/// conservatively answer "yes", in which case some errors will simply
778/// not be caught until template-instantiation.
779static IMAKind ClassifyImplicitMemberAccess(Sema &SemaRef,
780 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +0000781 assert(!R.empty() && (*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember());
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000782
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000783 DeclContext *DC = SemaRef.getFunctionLevelDeclContext();
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000784 bool isStaticContext =
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000785 (!isa<CXXMethodDecl>(DC) ||
786 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)->isStatic());
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000787
788 if (R.isUnresolvableResult())
789 return isStaticContext ? IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext : IMA_Unresolved;
790
791 // Collect all the declaring classes of instance members we find.
792 bool hasNonInstance = false;
793 llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*, 4> Classes;
794 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +0000795 NamedDecl *D = *I;
796 if (D->isCXXInstanceMember()) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000797 CXXRecordDecl *R = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
798
799 // If this is a member of an anonymous record, move out to the
800 // innermost non-anonymous struct or union. If there isn't one,
801 // that's a special case.
802 while (R->isAnonymousStructOrUnion()) {
803 R = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(R->getParent());
804 if (!R) return IMA_AnonymousMember;
805 }
806 Classes.insert(R->getCanonicalDecl());
807 }
808 else
809 hasNonInstance = true;
810 }
811
812 // If we didn't find any instance members, it can't be an implicit
813 // member reference.
814 if (Classes.empty())
815 return IMA_Static;
816
817 // If the current context is not an instance method, it can't be
818 // an implicit member reference.
819 if (isStaticContext)
820 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed_StaticContext : IMA_Error_StaticContext);
821
822 // If we can prove that the current context is unrelated to all the
823 // declaring classes, it can't be an implicit member reference (in
824 // which case it's an error if any of those members are selected).
825 if (IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(SemaRef,
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000826 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)->getParent(),
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000827 Classes))
828 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed_Unrelated : IMA_Error_Unrelated);
829
830 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed : IMA_Instance);
831}
832
833/// Diagnose a reference to a field with no object available.
834static void DiagnoseInstanceReference(Sema &SemaRef,
835 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
836 const LookupResult &R) {
837 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
838 SourceRange Range(Loc);
839 if (SS.isSet()) Range.setBegin(SS.getRange().getBegin());
840
841 if (R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>()) {
842 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(SemaRef.CurContext)) {
843 if (MD->isStatic()) {
844 // "invalid use of member 'x' in static member function"
845 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_member_use_in_static_method)
846 << Range << R.getLookupName();
847 return;
848 }
849 }
850
851 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_non_static_member_use)
852 << R.getLookupName() << Range;
853 return;
854 }
855
856 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_member_call_without_object) << Range;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000857}
858
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000859/// Diagnose an empty lookup.
860///
861/// \return false if new lookup candidates were found
Nick Lewyckyc96c37f2010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000862bool Sema::DiagnoseEmptyLookup(Scope *S, CXXScopeSpec &SS, LookupResult &R,
863 CorrectTypoContext CTC) {
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000864 DeclarationName Name = R.getLookupName();
865
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000866 unsigned diagnostic = diag::err_undeclared_var_use;
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000867 unsigned diagnostic_suggest = diag::err_undeclared_var_use_suggest;
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000868 if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXOperatorName ||
869 Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXLiteralOperatorName ||
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000870 Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConversionFunctionName) {
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000871 diagnostic = diag::err_undeclared_use;
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000872 diagnostic_suggest = diag::err_undeclared_use_suggest;
873 }
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000874
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000875 // If the original lookup was an unqualified lookup, fake an
876 // unqualified lookup. This is useful when (for example) the
877 // original lookup would not have found something because it was a
878 // dependent name.
Nick Lewyckyc96c37f2010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000879 for (DeclContext *DC = SS.isEmpty() ? CurContext : 0;
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000880 DC; DC = DC->getParent()) {
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000881 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)) {
882 LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
883
884 if (!R.empty()) {
885 // Don't give errors about ambiguities in this lookup.
886 R.suppressDiagnostics();
887
888 CXXMethodDecl *CurMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(CurContext);
889 bool isInstance = CurMethod &&
890 CurMethod->isInstance() &&
891 DC == CurMethod->getParent();
892
893 // Give a code modification hint to insert 'this->'.
894 // TODO: fixit for inserting 'Base<T>::' in the other cases.
895 // Actually quite difficult!
Nick Lewyckyc96c37f2010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000896 if (isInstance) {
Nick Lewyckyc96c37f2010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000897 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(
898 CallsUndergoingInstantiation.back()->getCallee());
Nick Lewyckyfe712382010-08-20 20:54:15 +0000899 CXXMethodDecl *DepMethod = cast_or_null<CXXMethodDecl>(
Nick Lewyckyc96c37f2010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000900 CurMethod->getInstantiatedFromMemberFunction());
Eli Friedman04831922010-08-22 01:00:03 +0000901 if (DepMethod) {
Nick Lewyckyfe712382010-08-20 20:54:15 +0000902 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name
903 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(R.getNameLoc(), "this->");
904 QualType DepThisType = DepMethod->getThisType(Context);
905 CXXThisExpr *DepThis = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(
906 R.getNameLoc(), DepThisType, false);
907 TemplateArgumentListInfo TList;
908 if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs())
909 ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TList);
910 CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr *DepExpr =
911 CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr::Create(
912 Context, DepThis, DepThisType, true, SourceLocation(),
913 ULE->getQualifier(), ULE->getQualifierRange(), NULL,
914 R.getLookupNameInfo(), &TList);
915 CallsUndergoingInstantiation.back()->setCallee(DepExpr);
Eli Friedman04831922010-08-22 01:00:03 +0000916 } else {
Nick Lewyckyfe712382010-08-20 20:54:15 +0000917 // FIXME: we should be able to handle this case too. It is correct
918 // to add this-> here. This is a workaround for PR7947.
919 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name;
Eli Friedman04831922010-08-22 01:00:03 +0000920 }
Nick Lewyckyc96c37f2010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000921 } else {
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000922 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name;
Nick Lewyckyc96c37f2010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000923 }
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000924
925 // Do we really want to note all of these?
926 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I)
927 Diag((*I)->getLocation(), diag::note_dependent_var_use);
928
929 // Tell the callee to try to recover.
930 return false;
931 }
Douglas Gregor86b8d9f2010-08-09 22:38:14 +0000932
933 R.clear();
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000934 }
935 }
936
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000937 // We didn't find anything, so try to correct for a typo.
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000938 DeclarationName Corrected;
Daniel Dunbarf7ced252010-06-02 15:46:52 +0000939 if (S && (Corrected = CorrectTypo(R, S, &SS, 0, false, CTC))) {
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000940 if (!R.empty()) {
941 if (isa<ValueDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*R.begin())) {
942 if (SS.isEmpty())
943 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << R.getLookupName()
944 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
945 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
946 else
947 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
948 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << R.getLookupName()
949 << SS.getRange()
950 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
951 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
952 if (NamedDecl *ND = R.getAsSingle<NamedDecl>())
953 Diag(ND->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
954 << ND->getDeclName();
955
956 // Tell the callee to try to recover.
957 return false;
958 }
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +0000959
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000960 if (isa<TypeDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(*R.begin())) {
961 // FIXME: If we ended up with a typo for a type name or
962 // Objective-C class name, we're in trouble because the parser
963 // is in the wrong place to recover. Suggest the typo
964 // correction, but don't make it a fix-it since we're not going
965 // to recover well anyway.
966 if (SS.isEmpty())
967 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << R.getLookupName();
968 else
969 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
970 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << R.getLookupName()
971 << SS.getRange();
972
973 // Don't try to recover; it won't work.
974 return true;
975 }
976 } else {
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +0000977 // FIXME: We found a keyword. Suggest it, but don't provide a fix-it
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000978 // because we aren't able to recover.
Douglas Gregor25363982010-01-01 00:15:04 +0000979 if (SS.isEmpty())
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000980 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << Corrected;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000981 else
Douglas Gregor25363982010-01-01 00:15:04 +0000982 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000983 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << Corrected
984 << SS.getRange();
Douglas Gregor25363982010-01-01 00:15:04 +0000985 return true;
986 }
Douglas Gregor25363982010-01-01 00:15:04 +0000987 R.clear();
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000988 }
989
990 // Emit a special diagnostic for failed member lookups.
991 // FIXME: computing the declaration context might fail here (?)
992 if (!SS.isEmpty()) {
993 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
994 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false)
995 << SS.getRange();
996 return true;
997 }
998
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000999 // Give up, we can't recover.
1000 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name;
1001 return true;
1002}
1003
Fariborz Jahanian86151342010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001004static ObjCPropertyDecl *OkToSynthesizeProvisionalIvar(Sema &SemaRef,
Fariborz Jahanian7b70eb42010-07-30 16:59:05 +00001005 IdentifierInfo *II,
1006 SourceLocation NameLoc) {
Fariborz Jahanian86151342010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001007 ObjCMethodDecl *CurMeth = SemaRef.getCurMethodDecl();
1008 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl = CurMeth->getClassInterface();
1009 if (!IDecl)
1010 return 0;
1011 ObjCImplementationDecl *ClassImpDecl = IDecl->getImplementation();
1012 if (!ClassImpDecl)
1013 return 0;
1014 ObjCPropertyDecl *property = SemaRef.LookupPropertyDecl(IDecl, II);
1015 if (!property)
1016 return 0;
1017 if (ObjCPropertyImplDecl *PIDecl = ClassImpDecl->FindPropertyImplDecl(II))
1018 if (PIDecl->getPropertyImplementation() == ObjCPropertyImplDecl::Dynamic)
1019 return 0;
1020 return property;
1021}
1022
Fariborz Jahanian18722982010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001023static ObjCIvarDecl *SynthesizeProvisionalIvar(Sema &SemaRef,
Fariborz Jahanian7b70eb42010-07-30 16:59:05 +00001024 LookupResult &Lookup,
Fariborz Jahanian18722982010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001025 IdentifierInfo *II,
1026 SourceLocation NameLoc) {
1027 ObjCMethodDecl *CurMeth = SemaRef.getCurMethodDecl();
Fariborz Jahanian7b70eb42010-07-30 16:59:05 +00001028 bool LookForIvars;
1029 if (Lookup.empty())
1030 LookForIvars = true;
1031 else if (CurMeth->isClassMethod())
1032 LookForIvars = false;
1033 else
1034 LookForIvars = (Lookup.isSingleResult() &&
1035 Lookup.getFoundDecl()->isDefinedOutsideFunctionOrMethod());
1036 if (!LookForIvars)
1037 return 0;
1038
Fariborz Jahanian18722982010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001039 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl = CurMeth->getClassInterface();
1040 if (!IDecl)
1041 return 0;
1042 ObjCImplementationDecl *ClassImpDecl = IDecl->getImplementation();
Fariborz Jahanian2a360892010-07-19 16:14:33 +00001043 if (!ClassImpDecl)
1044 return 0;
Fariborz Jahanian18722982010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001045 bool DynamicImplSeen = false;
1046 ObjCPropertyDecl *property = SemaRef.LookupPropertyDecl(IDecl, II);
1047 if (!property)
1048 return 0;
1049 if (ObjCPropertyImplDecl *PIDecl = ClassImpDecl->FindPropertyImplDecl(II))
1050 DynamicImplSeen =
1051 (PIDecl->getPropertyImplementation() == ObjCPropertyImplDecl::Dynamic);
1052 if (!DynamicImplSeen) {
Fariborz Jahanian2a360892010-07-19 16:14:33 +00001053 QualType PropType = SemaRef.Context.getCanonicalType(property->getType());
1054 ObjCIvarDecl *Ivar = ObjCIvarDecl::Create(SemaRef.Context, ClassImpDecl,
Fariborz Jahanian18722982010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001055 NameLoc,
1056 II, PropType, /*Dinfo=*/0,
1057 ObjCIvarDecl::Protected,
1058 (Expr *)0, true);
1059 ClassImpDecl->addDecl(Ivar);
1060 IDecl->makeDeclVisibleInContext(Ivar, false);
1061 property->setPropertyIvarDecl(Ivar);
1062 return Ivar;
1063 }
1064 return 0;
1065}
1066
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001067ExprResult Sema::ActOnIdExpression(Scope *S,
John McCall24d18942010-08-24 22:52:39 +00001068 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1069 UnqualifiedId &Id,
1070 bool HasTrailingLParen,
1071 bool isAddressOfOperand) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001072 assert(!(isAddressOfOperand && HasTrailingLParen) &&
1073 "cannot be direct & operand and have a trailing lparen");
1074
1075 if (SS.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregored8f2882009-01-30 01:04:22 +00001076 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor90a1a652009-03-19 17:26:29 +00001077
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001078 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer;
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001079
1080 // Decompose the UnqualifiedId into the following data.
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001081 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo;
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001082 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs;
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001083 DecomposeUnqualifiedId(*this, Id, TemplateArgsBuffer, NameInfo, TemplateArgs);
Douglas Gregor90a1a652009-03-19 17:26:29 +00001084
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001085 DeclarationName Name = NameInfo.getName();
Douglas Gregor4ea80432008-11-18 15:03:34 +00001086 IdentifierInfo *II = Name.getAsIdentifierInfo();
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001087 SourceLocation NameLoc = NameInfo.getLoc();
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001088
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001089 // C++ [temp.dep.expr]p3:
1090 // An id-expression is type-dependent if it contains:
Douglas Gregorea0a0a92010-01-11 18:40:55 +00001091 // -- an identifier that was declared with a dependent type,
1092 // (note: handled after lookup)
1093 // -- a template-id that is dependent,
1094 // (note: handled in BuildTemplateIdExpr)
1095 // -- a conversion-function-id that specifies a dependent type,
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001096 // -- a nested-name-specifier that contains a class-name that
1097 // names a dependent type.
1098 // Determine whether this is a member of an unknown specialization;
1099 // we need to handle these differently.
Eli Friedman964dbda2010-08-06 23:41:47 +00001100 bool DependentID = false;
1101 if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConversionFunctionName &&
1102 Name.getCXXNameType()->isDependentType()) {
1103 DependentID = true;
1104 } else if (SS.isSet()) {
1105 DeclContext *DC = computeDeclContext(SS, false);
1106 if (DC) {
1107 if (RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC))
1108 return ExprError();
1109 // FIXME: We should be checking whether DC is the current instantiation.
1110 if (CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC))
1111 DependentID = !IsFullyFormedScope(*this, RD);
1112 } else {
1113 DependentID = true;
1114 }
1115 }
1116
1117 if (DependentID) {
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001118 return ActOnDependentIdExpression(SS, NameInfo, isAddressOfOperand,
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001119 TemplateArgs);
1120 }
Fariborz Jahanian86151342010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001121 bool IvarLookupFollowUp = false;
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001122 // Perform the required lookup.
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001123 LookupResult R(*this, NameInfo, LookupOrdinaryName);
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001124 if (TemplateArgs) {
Douglas Gregor3e51e172010-05-20 20:58:56 +00001125 // Lookup the template name again to correctly establish the context in
1126 // which it was found. This is really unfortunate as we already did the
1127 // lookup to determine that it was a template name in the first place. If
1128 // this becomes a performance hit, we can work harder to preserve those
1129 // results until we get here but it's likely not worth it.
Douglas Gregor786123d2010-05-21 23:18:07 +00001130 bool MemberOfUnknownSpecialization;
1131 LookupTemplateName(R, S, SS, QualType(), /*EnteringContext=*/false,
1132 MemberOfUnknownSpecialization);
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001133 } else {
Fariborz Jahanian86151342010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001134 IvarLookupFollowUp = (!SS.isSet() && II && getCurMethodDecl());
Fariborz Jahanian6fada5b2010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001135 LookupParsedName(R, S, &SS, !IvarLookupFollowUp);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001136
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001137 // If this reference is in an Objective-C method, then we need to do
1138 // some special Objective-C lookup, too.
Fariborz Jahanian6fada5b2010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001139 if (IvarLookupFollowUp) {
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001140 ExprResult E(LookupInObjCMethod(R, S, II, true));
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001141 if (E.isInvalid())
1142 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001143
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001144 Expr *Ex = E.takeAs<Expr>();
1145 if (Ex) return Owned(Ex);
Fariborz Jahanian18722982010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001146 // Synthesize ivars lazily
1147 if (getLangOptions().ObjCNonFragileABI2) {
Fariborz Jahanian7b70eb42010-07-30 16:59:05 +00001148 if (SynthesizeProvisionalIvar(*this, R, II, NameLoc))
Fariborz Jahanian18722982010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001149 return ActOnIdExpression(S, SS, Id, HasTrailingLParen,
1150 isAddressOfOperand);
1151 }
Fariborz Jahanian18d90a92010-08-13 18:09:39 +00001152 // for further use, this must be set to false if in class method.
1153 IvarLookupFollowUp = getCurMethodDecl()->isInstanceMethod();
Steve Naroffebf4cb42008-06-02 23:03:37 +00001154 }
Chris Lattner59a25942008-03-31 00:36:02 +00001155 }
Douglas Gregorf15f5d32009-02-16 19:28:42 +00001156
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001157 if (R.isAmbiguous())
1158 return ExprError();
1159
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001160 // Determine whether this name might be a candidate for
1161 // argument-dependent lookup.
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001162 bool ADL = UseArgumentDependentLookup(SS, R, HasTrailingLParen);
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001163
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001164 if (R.empty() && !ADL) {
Bill Wendling4073ed52007-02-13 01:51:42 +00001165 // Otherwise, this could be an implicitly declared function reference (legal
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001166 // in C90, extension in C99, forbidden in C++).
1167 if (HasTrailingLParen && II && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
1168 NamedDecl *D = ImplicitlyDefineFunction(NameLoc, *II, S);
1169 if (D) R.addDecl(D);
1170 }
1171
1172 // If this name wasn't predeclared and if this is not a function
1173 // call, diagnose the problem.
1174 if (R.empty()) {
Douglas Gregor5fd04d42010-05-18 16:14:23 +00001175 if (DiagnoseEmptyLookup(S, SS, R, CTC_Unknown))
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00001176 return ExprError();
1177
1178 assert(!R.empty() &&
1179 "DiagnoseEmptyLookup returned false but added no results");
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00001180
1181 // If we found an Objective-C instance variable, let
1182 // LookupInObjCMethod build the appropriate expression to
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001183 // reference the ivar.
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00001184 if (ObjCIvarDecl *Ivar = R.getAsSingle<ObjCIvarDecl>()) {
1185 R.clear();
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001186 ExprResult E(LookupInObjCMethod(R, S, Ivar->getIdentifier()));
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00001187 assert(E.isInvalid() || E.get());
1188 return move(E);
1189 }
Steve Naroff92e30f82007-04-02 22:35:25 +00001190 }
Chris Lattner17ed4872006-11-20 04:58:19 +00001191 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001192
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001193 // This is guaranteed from this point on.
1194 assert(!R.empty() || ADL);
1195
1196 if (VarDecl *Var = R.getAsSingle<VarDecl>()) {
Fariborz Jahanian86151342010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001197 if (getLangOptions().ObjCNonFragileABI && IvarLookupFollowUp &&
Fariborz Jahanianc15dfd82010-07-29 16:53:53 +00001198 !getLangOptions().ObjCNonFragileABI2 &&
1199 Var->isFileVarDecl()) {
Fariborz Jahanian86151342010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001200 ObjCPropertyDecl *Property =
1201 OkToSynthesizeProvisionalIvar(*this, II, NameLoc);
1202 if (Property) {
1203 Diag(NameLoc, diag::warn_ivar_variable_conflict) << Var->getDeclName();
1204 Diag(Property->getLocation(), diag::note_property_declare);
Fariborz Jahanian18d90a92010-08-13 18:09:39 +00001205 Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::note_global_declared_at);
Fariborz Jahanian86151342010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001206 }
1207 }
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001208 } else if (FunctionDecl *Func = R.getAsSingle<FunctionDecl>()) {
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001209 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && !Func->hasPrototype()) {
1210 // C99 DR 316 says that, if a function type comes from a
1211 // function definition (without a prototype), that type is only
1212 // used for checking compatibility. Therefore, when referencing
1213 // the function, we pretend that we don't have the full function
1214 // type.
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001215 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Func, NameLoc))
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001216 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001217
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001218 QualType T = Func->getType();
1219 QualType NoProtoType = T;
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001220 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = T->getAs<FunctionProtoType>())
Eli Friedmanb41ad0f2010-05-17 02:50:18 +00001221 NoProtoType = Context.getFunctionNoProtoType(Proto->getResultType(),
1222 Proto->getExtInfo());
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001223 return BuildDeclRefExpr(Func, NoProtoType, NameLoc, &SS);
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001224 }
1225 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001226
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001227 // Check whether this might be a C++ implicit instance member access.
John McCall24d18942010-08-24 22:52:39 +00001228 // C++ [class.mfct.non-static]p3:
1229 // When an id-expression that is not part of a class member access
1230 // syntax and not used to form a pointer to member is used in the
1231 // body of a non-static member function of class X, if name lookup
1232 // resolves the name in the id-expression to a non-static non-type
1233 // member of some class C, the id-expression is transformed into a
1234 // class member access expression using (*this) as the
1235 // postfix-expression to the left of the . operator.
John McCall8d08b9b2010-08-27 09:08:28 +00001236 //
1237 // But we don't actually need to do this for '&' operands if R
1238 // resolved to a function or overloaded function set, because the
1239 // expression is ill-formed if it actually works out to be a
1240 // non-static member function:
1241 //
1242 // C++ [expr.ref]p4:
1243 // Otherwise, if E1.E2 refers to a non-static member function. . .
1244 // [t]he expression can be used only as the left-hand operand of a
1245 // member function call.
1246 //
1247 // There are other safeguards against such uses, but it's important
1248 // to get this right here so that we don't end up making a
1249 // spuriously dependent expression if we're inside a dependent
1250 // instance method.
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001251 if (!R.empty() && (*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember()) {
John McCall8d08b9b2010-08-27 09:08:28 +00001252 bool MightBeImplicitMember;
1253 if (!isAddressOfOperand)
1254 MightBeImplicitMember = true;
1255 else if (!SS.isEmpty())
1256 MightBeImplicitMember = false;
1257 else if (R.isOverloadedResult())
1258 MightBeImplicitMember = false;
Douglas Gregor1262b062010-08-30 16:00:47 +00001259 else if (R.isUnresolvableResult())
1260 MightBeImplicitMember = true;
John McCall8d08b9b2010-08-27 09:08:28 +00001261 else
1262 MightBeImplicitMember = isa<FieldDecl>(R.getFoundDecl());
1263
1264 if (MightBeImplicitMember)
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001265 return BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs);
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001266 }
1267
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001268 if (TemplateArgs)
1269 return BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, R, ADL, *TemplateArgs);
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001270
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001271 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, ADL);
1272}
1273
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001274/// Builds an expression which might be an implicit member expression.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001275ExprResult
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001276Sema::BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1277 LookupResult &R,
1278 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
1279 switch (ClassifyImplicitMemberAccess(*this, R)) {
1280 case IMA_Instance:
1281 return BuildImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs, true);
1282
1283 case IMA_AnonymousMember:
1284 assert(R.isSingleResult());
1285 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(R.getNameLoc(),
1286 R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>());
1287
1288 case IMA_Mixed:
1289 case IMA_Mixed_Unrelated:
1290 case IMA_Unresolved:
1291 return BuildImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs, false);
1292
1293 case IMA_Static:
1294 case IMA_Mixed_StaticContext:
1295 case IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext:
1296 if (TemplateArgs)
1297 return BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, R, false, *TemplateArgs);
1298 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, false);
1299
1300 case IMA_Error_StaticContext:
1301 case IMA_Error_Unrelated:
1302 DiagnoseInstanceReference(*this, SS, R);
1303 return ExprError();
1304 }
1305
1306 llvm_unreachable("unexpected instance member access kind");
1307 return ExprError();
1308}
1309
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001310/// BuildQualifiedDeclarationNameExpr - Build a C++ qualified
1311/// declaration name, generally during template instantiation.
1312/// There's a large number of things which don't need to be done along
1313/// this path.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001314ExprResult
Jeffrey Yasskinc76498d2010-04-08 16:38:48 +00001315Sema::BuildQualifiedDeclarationNameExpr(CXXScopeSpec &SS,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001316 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001317 DeclContext *DC;
Douglas Gregora02bb342010-04-28 07:04:26 +00001318 if (!(DC = computeDeclContext(SS, false)) || DC->isDependentContext())
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001319 return BuildDependentDeclRefExpr(SS, NameInfo, 0);
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001320
John McCall0b66eb32010-05-01 00:40:08 +00001321 if (RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC))
Douglas Gregora02bb342010-04-28 07:04:26 +00001322 return ExprError();
1323
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001324 LookupResult R(*this, NameInfo, LookupOrdinaryName);
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001325 LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
1326
1327 if (R.isAmbiguous())
1328 return ExprError();
1329
1330 if (R.empty()) {
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001331 Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
1332 << NameInfo.getName() << DC << SS.getRange();
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001333 return ExprError();
1334 }
1335
1336 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, /*ADL*/ false);
1337}
1338
1339/// LookupInObjCMethod - The parser has read a name in, and Sema has
1340/// detected that we're currently inside an ObjC method. Perform some
1341/// additional lookup.
1342///
1343/// Ideally, most of this would be done by lookup, but there's
1344/// actually quite a lot of extra work involved.
1345///
1346/// Returns a null sentinel to indicate trivial success.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001347ExprResult
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001348Sema::LookupInObjCMethod(LookupResult &Lookup, Scope *S,
Chris Lattnera36ec422010-04-11 08:28:14 +00001349 IdentifierInfo *II, bool AllowBuiltinCreation) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001350 SourceLocation Loc = Lookup.getNameLoc();
Chris Lattner87313662010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001351 ObjCMethodDecl *CurMethod = getCurMethodDecl();
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00001352
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001353 // There are two cases to handle here. 1) scoped lookup could have failed,
1354 // in which case we should look for an ivar. 2) scoped lookup could have
1355 // found a decl, but that decl is outside the current instance method (i.e.
1356 // a global variable). In these two cases, we do a lookup for an ivar with
1357 // this name, if the lookup sucedes, we replace it our current decl.
1358
1359 // If we're in a class method, we don't normally want to look for
1360 // ivars. But if we don't find anything else, and there's an
1361 // ivar, that's an error.
Chris Lattner87313662010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001362 bool IsClassMethod = CurMethod->isClassMethod();
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001363
1364 bool LookForIvars;
1365 if (Lookup.empty())
1366 LookForIvars = true;
1367 else if (IsClassMethod)
1368 LookForIvars = false;
1369 else
1370 LookForIvars = (Lookup.isSingleResult() &&
1371 Lookup.getFoundDecl()->isDefinedOutsideFunctionOrMethod());
Fariborz Jahanian45878032010-02-09 19:31:38 +00001372 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = 0;
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001373 if (LookForIvars) {
Chris Lattner87313662010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001374 IFace = CurMethod->getClassInterface();
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001375 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
1376 if (ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IFace->lookupInstanceVariable(II, ClassDeclared)) {
1377 // Diagnose using an ivar in a class method.
1378 if (IsClassMethod)
1379 return ExprError(Diag(Loc, diag::error_ivar_use_in_class_method)
1380 << IV->getDeclName());
1381
1382 // If we're referencing an invalid decl, just return this as a silent
1383 // error node. The error diagnostic was already emitted on the decl.
1384 if (IV->isInvalidDecl())
1385 return ExprError();
1386
1387 // Check if referencing a field with __attribute__((deprecated)).
1388 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(IV, Loc))
1389 return ExprError();
1390
1391 // Diagnose the use of an ivar outside of the declaring class.
1392 if (IV->getAccessControl() == ObjCIvarDecl::Private &&
1393 ClassDeclared != IFace)
1394 Diag(Loc, diag::error_private_ivar_access) << IV->getDeclName();
1395
1396 // FIXME: This should use a new expr for a direct reference, don't
1397 // turn this into Self->ivar, just return a BareIVarExpr or something.
1398 IdentifierInfo &II = Context.Idents.get("self");
1399 UnqualifiedId SelfName;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001400 SelfName.setIdentifier(&II, SourceLocation());
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001401 CXXScopeSpec SelfScopeSpec;
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001402 ExprResult SelfExpr = ActOnIdExpression(S, SelfScopeSpec,
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001403 SelfName, false, false);
1404 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, IV);
1405 return Owned(new (Context)
1406 ObjCIvarRefExpr(IV, IV->getType(), Loc,
1407 SelfExpr.takeAs<Expr>(), true, true));
1408 }
Chris Lattner87313662010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001409 } else if (CurMethod->isInstanceMethod()) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001410 // We should warn if a local variable hides an ivar.
Chris Lattner87313662010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001411 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = CurMethod->getClassInterface();
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001412 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
1413 if (ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IFace->lookupInstanceVariable(II, ClassDeclared)) {
1414 if (IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Private ||
1415 IFace == ClassDeclared)
1416 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_ivar_use_hidden) << IV->getDeclName();
1417 }
1418 }
1419
Fariborz Jahanian6fada5b2010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001420 if (Lookup.empty() && II && AllowBuiltinCreation) {
1421 // FIXME. Consolidate this with similar code in LookupName.
1422 if (unsigned BuiltinID = II->getBuiltinID()) {
1423 if (!(getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
1424 Context.BuiltinInfo.isPredefinedLibFunction(BuiltinID))) {
1425 NamedDecl *D = LazilyCreateBuiltin((IdentifierInfo *)II, BuiltinID,
1426 S, Lookup.isForRedeclaration(),
1427 Lookup.getNameLoc());
1428 if (D) Lookup.addDecl(D);
1429 }
1430 }
1431 }
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001432 // Sentinel value saying that we didn't do anything special.
1433 return Owned((Expr*) 0);
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001434}
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001435
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001436/// \brief Cast a base object to a member's actual type.
1437///
1438/// Logically this happens in three phases:
1439///
1440/// * First we cast from the base type to the naming class.
1441/// The naming class is the class into which we were looking
1442/// when we found the member; it's the qualifier type if a
1443/// qualifier was provided, and otherwise it's the base type.
1444///
1445/// * Next we cast from the naming class to the declaring class.
1446/// If the member we found was brought into a class's scope by
1447/// a using declaration, this is that class; otherwise it's
1448/// the class declaring the member.
1449///
1450/// * Finally we cast from the declaring class to the "true"
1451/// declaring class of the member. This conversion does not
1452/// obey access control.
Fariborz Jahanian3f150832009-07-29 19:40:11 +00001453bool
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001454Sema::PerformObjectMemberConversion(Expr *&From,
1455 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001456 NamedDecl *FoundDecl,
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001457 NamedDecl *Member) {
1458 CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Member->getDeclContext());
1459 if (!RD)
1460 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001461
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001462 QualType DestRecordType;
1463 QualType DestType;
1464 QualType FromRecordType;
1465 QualType FromType = From->getType();
1466 bool PointerConversions = false;
1467 if (isa<FieldDecl>(Member)) {
1468 DestRecordType = Context.getCanonicalType(Context.getTypeDeclType(RD));
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001469
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001470 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
1471 DestType = Context.getPointerType(DestRecordType);
1472 FromRecordType = FromType->getPointeeType();
1473 PointerConversions = true;
1474 } else {
1475 DestType = DestRecordType;
1476 FromRecordType = FromType;
Fariborz Jahanianbb67b822009-07-29 18:40:24 +00001477 }
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001478 } else if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Member)) {
1479 if (Method->isStatic())
1480 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001481
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001482 DestType = Method->getThisType(Context);
1483 DestRecordType = DestType->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001484
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001485 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
1486 FromRecordType = FromType->getPointeeType();
1487 PointerConversions = true;
1488 } else {
1489 FromRecordType = FromType;
1490 DestType = DestRecordType;
1491 }
1492 } else {
1493 // No conversion necessary.
1494 return false;
1495 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001496
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001497 if (DestType->isDependentType() || FromType->isDependentType())
1498 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001499
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001500 // If the unqualified types are the same, no conversion is necessary.
1501 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, DestRecordType))
1502 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001503
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001504 SourceRange FromRange = From->getSourceRange();
1505 SourceLocation FromLoc = FromRange.getBegin();
1506
John McCall2536c6d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +00001507 ExprValueKind VK = CastCategory(From);
Sebastian Redlc57d34b2010-07-20 04:20:21 +00001508
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001509 // C++ [class.member.lookup]p8:
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001510 // [...] Ambiguities can often be resolved by qualifying a name with its
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001511 // class name.
1512 //
1513 // If the member was a qualified name and the qualified referred to a
1514 // specific base subobject type, we'll cast to that intermediate type
1515 // first and then to the object in which the member is declared. That allows
1516 // one to resolve ambiguities in, e.g., a diamond-shaped hierarchy such as:
1517 //
1518 // class Base { public: int x; };
1519 // class Derived1 : public Base { };
1520 // class Derived2 : public Base { };
1521 // class VeryDerived : public Derived1, public Derived2 { void f(); };
1522 //
1523 // void VeryDerived::f() {
1524 // x = 17; // error: ambiguous base subobjects
1525 // Derived1::x = 17; // okay, pick the Base subobject of Derived1
1526 // }
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001527 if (Qualifier) {
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001528 QualType QType = QualType(Qualifier->getAsType(), 0);
1529 assert(!QType.isNull() && "lookup done with dependent qualifier?");
1530 assert(QType->isRecordType() && "lookup done with non-record type");
1531
1532 QualType QRecordType = QualType(QType->getAs<RecordType>(), 0);
1533
1534 // In C++98, the qualifier type doesn't actually have to be a base
1535 // type of the object type, in which case we just ignore it.
1536 // Otherwise build the appropriate casts.
1537 if (IsDerivedFrom(FromRecordType, QRecordType)) {
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00001538 CXXCastPath BasePath;
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001539 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, QRecordType,
Anders Carlssonb78feca2010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001540 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath))
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001541 return true;
1542
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001543 if (PointerConversions)
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001544 QType = Context.getPointerType(QType);
John McCall2536c6d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +00001545 ImpCastExprToType(From, QType, CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
1546 VK, &BasePath);
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001547
1548 FromType = QType;
1549 FromRecordType = QRecordType;
1550
1551 // If the qualifier type was the same as the destination type,
1552 // we're done.
1553 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, DestRecordType))
1554 return false;
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001555 }
1556 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001557
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001558 bool IgnoreAccess = false;
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001559
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001560 // If we actually found the member through a using declaration, cast
1561 // down to the using declaration's type.
1562 //
1563 // Pointer equality is fine here because only one declaration of a
1564 // class ever has member declarations.
1565 if (FoundDecl->getDeclContext() != Member->getDeclContext()) {
1566 assert(isa<UsingShadowDecl>(FoundDecl));
1567 QualType URecordType = Context.getTypeDeclType(
1568 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FoundDecl->getDeclContext()));
1569
1570 // We only need to do this if the naming-class to declaring-class
1571 // conversion is non-trivial.
1572 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, URecordType)) {
1573 assert(IsDerivedFrom(FromRecordType, URecordType));
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00001574 CXXCastPath BasePath;
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001575 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, URecordType,
Anders Carlssonb78feca2010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001576 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath))
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001577 return true;
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00001578
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001579 QualType UType = URecordType;
1580 if (PointerConversions)
1581 UType = Context.getPointerType(UType);
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00001582 ImpCastExprToType(From, UType, CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
John McCall2536c6d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +00001583 VK, &BasePath);
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001584 FromType = UType;
1585 FromRecordType = URecordType;
1586 }
1587
1588 // We don't do access control for the conversion from the
1589 // declaring class to the true declaring class.
1590 IgnoreAccess = true;
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001591 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001592
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00001593 CXXCastPath BasePath;
Anders Carlssonb78feca2010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001594 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, DestRecordType,
1595 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001596 IgnoreAccess))
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001597 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001598
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00001599 ImpCastExprToType(From, DestType, CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
John McCall2536c6d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +00001600 VK, &BasePath);
Fariborz Jahanian3f150832009-07-29 19:40:11 +00001601 return false;
Fariborz Jahanianbb67b822009-07-29 18:40:24 +00001602}
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001603
Douglas Gregorf405d7e2009-08-31 23:41:50 +00001604/// \brief Build a MemberExpr AST node.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001605static MemberExpr *BuildMemberExpr(ASTContext &C, Expr *Base, bool isArrow,
Eli Friedman2cfcef62009-12-04 06:40:45 +00001606 const CXXScopeSpec &SS, ValueDecl *Member,
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00001607 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001608 const DeclarationNameInfo &MemberNameInfo,
1609 QualType Ty,
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001610 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs = 0) {
1611 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier = 0;
1612 SourceRange QualifierRange;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001613 if (SS.isSet()) {
1614 Qualifier = (NestedNameSpecifier *) SS.getScopeRep();
1615 QualifierRange = SS.getRange();
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001616 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001617
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001618 return MemberExpr::Create(C, Base, isArrow, Qualifier, QualifierRange,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001619 Member, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
1620 TemplateArgs, Ty);
Douglas Gregorc1905232009-08-26 22:36:53 +00001621}
1622
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001623/// Builds an implicit member access expression. The current context
1624/// is known to be an instance method, and the given unqualified lookup
1625/// set is known to contain only instance members, at least one of which
1626/// is from an appropriate type.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001627ExprResult
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001628Sema::BuildImplicitMemberExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1629 LookupResult &R,
1630 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs,
1631 bool IsKnownInstance) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001632 assert(!R.empty() && !R.isAmbiguous());
1633
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001634 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00001635
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001636 // We may have found a field within an anonymous union or struct
1637 // (C++ [class.union]).
Douglas Gregor6493d9c2009-10-22 07:08:30 +00001638 // FIXME: This needs to happen post-isImplicitMemberReference?
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001639 // FIXME: template-ids inside anonymous structs?
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001640 if (FieldDecl *FD = R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>())
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001641 if (cast<RecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion())
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001642 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(Loc, FD);
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001643
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001644 // If this is known to be an instance access, go ahead and build a
1645 // 'this' expression now.
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +00001646 DeclContext *DC = getFunctionLevelDeclContext();
1647 QualType ThisType = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)->getThisType(Context);
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001648 Expr *This = 0; // null signifies implicit access
1649 if (IsKnownInstance) {
Douglas Gregorb15af892010-01-07 23:12:05 +00001650 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
1651 if (SS.getRange().isValid())
1652 Loc = SS.getRange().getBegin();
1653 This = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc, ThisType, /*isImplicit=*/true);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00001654 }
1655
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00001656 return BuildMemberReferenceExpr(This, ThisType,
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001657 /*OpLoc*/ SourceLocation(),
1658 /*IsArrow*/ true,
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00001659 SS,
1660 /*FirstQualifierInScope*/ 0,
1661 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001662}
1663
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001664bool Sema::UseArgumentDependentLookup(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001665 const LookupResult &R,
1666 bool HasTrailingLParen) {
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001667 // Only when used directly as the postfix-expression of a call.
1668 if (!HasTrailingLParen)
1669 return false;
1670
1671 // Never if a scope specifier was provided.
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001672 if (SS.isSet())
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001673 return false;
1674
1675 // Only in C++ or ObjC++.
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001676 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001677 return false;
1678
1679 // Turn off ADL when we find certain kinds of declarations during
1680 // normal lookup:
1681 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
1682 NamedDecl *D = *I;
1683
1684 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1685 // -- a declaration of a class member
1686 // Since using decls preserve this property, we check this on the
1687 // original decl.
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001688 if (D->isCXXClassMember())
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001689 return false;
1690
1691 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1692 // -- a block-scope function declaration that is not a
1693 // using-declaration
1694 // NOTE: we also trigger this for function templates (in fact, we
1695 // don't check the decl type at all, since all other decl types
1696 // turn off ADL anyway).
1697 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
1698 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
1699 else if (D->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod())
1700 return false;
1701
1702 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1703 // -- a declaration that is neither a function or a function
1704 // template
1705 // And also for builtin functions.
1706 if (isa<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
1707 FunctionDecl *FDecl = cast<FunctionDecl>(D);
1708
1709 // But also builtin functions.
1710 if (FDecl->getBuiltinID() && FDecl->isImplicit())
1711 return false;
1712 } else if (!isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D))
1713 return false;
1714 }
1715
1716 return true;
1717}
1718
1719
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001720/// Diagnoses obvious problems with the use of the given declaration
1721/// as an expression. This is only actually called for lookups that
1722/// were not overloaded, and it doesn't promise that the declaration
1723/// will in fact be used.
1724static bool CheckDeclInExpr(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, NamedDecl *D) {
1725 if (isa<TypedefDecl>(D)) {
1726 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_typedef) << D->getDeclName();
1727 return true;
1728 }
1729
1730 if (isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(D)) {
1731 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_interface) << D->getDeclName();
1732 return true;
1733 }
1734
1735 if (isa<NamespaceDecl>(D)) {
1736 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_namespace) << D->getDeclName();
1737 return true;
1738 }
1739
1740 return false;
1741}
1742
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001743ExprResult
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001744Sema::BuildDeclarationNameExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001745 LookupResult &R,
1746 bool NeedsADL) {
John McCall3a60c872009-12-08 22:45:53 +00001747 // If this is a single, fully-resolved result and we don't need ADL,
1748 // just build an ordinary singleton decl ref.
Douglas Gregor4b4844f2010-01-29 17:15:43 +00001749 if (!NeedsADL && R.isSingleResult() && !R.getAsSingle<FunctionTemplateDecl>())
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001750 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R.getLookupNameInfo(),
1751 R.getFoundDecl());
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001752
1753 // We only need to check the declaration if there's exactly one
1754 // result, because in the overloaded case the results can only be
1755 // functions and function templates.
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001756 if (R.isSingleResult() &&
1757 CheckDeclInExpr(*this, R.getNameLoc(), R.getFoundDecl()))
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001758 return ExprError();
1759
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00001760 // Otherwise, just build an unresolved lookup expression. Suppress
1761 // any lookup-related diagnostics; we'll hash these out later, when
1762 // we've picked a target.
1763 R.suppressDiagnostics();
1764
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001765 bool Dependent
1766 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::ComputeDependence(R.begin(), R.end(), 0);
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001767 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00001768 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, Dependent, R.getNamingClass(),
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001769 (NestedNameSpecifier*) SS.getScopeRep(),
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001770 SS.getRange(), R.getLookupNameInfo(),
Douglas Gregor30a4f4c2010-05-23 18:57:34 +00001771 NeedsADL, R.isOverloadedResult(),
1772 R.begin(), R.end());
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001773
1774 return Owned(ULE);
1775}
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001776
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001777
1778/// \brief Complete semantic analysis for a reference to the given declaration.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001779ExprResult
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001780Sema::BuildDeclarationNameExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001781 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
1782 NamedDecl *D) {
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001783 assert(D && "Cannot refer to a NULL declaration");
John McCall283b9012009-11-22 00:44:51 +00001784 assert(!isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D) &&
1785 "Cannot refer unambiguously to a function template");
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001786
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001787 SourceLocation Loc = NameInfo.getLoc();
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001788 if (CheckDeclInExpr(*this, Loc, D))
1789 return ExprError();
Steve Narofff1e53692007-03-23 22:27:02 +00001790
Douglas Gregore7488b92009-12-01 16:58:18 +00001791 if (TemplateDecl *Template = dyn_cast<TemplateDecl>(D)) {
1792 // Specifically diagnose references to class templates that are missing
1793 // a template argument list.
1794 Diag(Loc, diag::err_template_decl_ref)
1795 << Template << SS.getRange();
1796 Diag(Template->getLocation(), diag::note_template_decl_here);
1797 return ExprError();
1798 }
1799
1800 // Make sure that we're referring to a value.
1801 ValueDecl *VD = dyn_cast<ValueDecl>(D);
1802 if (!VD) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001803 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_non_value)
Douglas Gregore7488b92009-12-01 16:58:18 +00001804 << D << SS.getRange();
John McCallb48971d2009-12-18 18:35:10 +00001805 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
Douglas Gregore7488b92009-12-01 16:58:18 +00001806 return ExprError();
1807 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001808
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001809 // Check whether this declaration can be used. Note that we suppress
1810 // this check when we're going to perform argument-dependent lookup
1811 // on this function name, because this might not be the function
1812 // that overload resolution actually selects.
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001813 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(VD, Loc))
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001814 return ExprError();
1815
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00001816 // Only create DeclRefExpr's for valid Decl's.
1817 if (VD->isInvalidDecl())
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001818 return ExprError();
1819
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +00001820 // If the identifier reference is inside a block, and it refers to a value
1821 // that is outside the block, create a BlockDeclRefExpr instead of a
1822 // DeclRefExpr. This ensures the value is treated as a copy-in snapshot when
1823 // the block is formed.
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00001824 //
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +00001825 // We do not do this for things like enum constants, global variables, etc,
1826 // as they do not get snapshotted.
1827 //
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001828 if (getCurBlock() &&
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00001829 ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference(*this, getCurBlock(), VD)) {
Mike Stump7dafa0d2010-01-05 02:56:35 +00001830 if (VD->getType().getTypePtr()->isVariablyModifiedType()) {
1831 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_vm_type);
1832 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
1833 return ExprError();
1834 }
1835
Fariborz Jahanianfa24e102010-03-16 23:39:51 +00001836 if (VD->getType()->isArrayType()) {
Mike Stump8971a862010-01-05 03:10:36 +00001837 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_array_type);
1838 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
1839 return ExprError();
1840 }
1841
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00001842 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, VD);
Eli Friedman7fa3faa2009-03-22 23:00:19 +00001843 QualType ExprTy = VD->getType().getNonReferenceType();
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00001844 // The BlocksAttr indicates the variable is bound by-reference.
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb4b64ca2009-06-30 02:34:44 +00001845 if (VD->getAttr<BlocksAttr>())
Eli Friedman7fa3faa2009-03-22 23:00:19 +00001846 return Owned(new (Context) BlockDeclRefExpr(VD, ExprTy, Loc, true));
Fariborz Jahanian3fd73102009-06-19 23:37:08 +00001847 // This is to record that a 'const' was actually synthesize and added.
1848 bool constAdded = !ExprTy.isConstQualified();
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00001849 // Variable will be bound by-copy, make it const within the closure.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001850
Eli Friedman7fa3faa2009-03-22 23:00:19 +00001851 ExprTy.addConst();
Fariborz Jahanian70c0b082010-07-12 17:26:57 +00001852 QualType T = VD->getType();
Fariborz Jahanianea882cd2010-06-04 21:35:44 +00001853 BlockDeclRefExpr *BDRE = new (Context) BlockDeclRefExpr(VD,
1854 ExprTy, Loc, false,
Fariborz Jahanianc289bce2010-07-12 18:12:03 +00001855 constAdded);
Fariborz Jahanian4239aa12010-07-09 22:21:32 +00001856 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
1857 if (!T->isDependentType() && !T->isReferenceType()) {
1858 Expr *E = new (Context)
1859 DeclRefExpr(const_cast<ValueDecl*>(BDRE->getDecl()), T,
1860 SourceLocation());
Fariborz Jahanianea882cd2010-06-04 21:35:44 +00001861
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001862 ExprResult Res = PerformCopyInitialization(
Fariborz Jahanian4239aa12010-07-09 22:21:32 +00001863 InitializedEntity::InitializeBlock(VD->getLocation(),
Fariborz Jahanian28ed9272010-06-07 16:14:00 +00001864 T, false),
Fariborz Jahanian4239aa12010-07-09 22:21:32 +00001865 SourceLocation(),
1866 Owned(E));
1867 if (!Res.isInvalid()) {
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00001868 Res = MaybeCreateCXXExprWithTemporaries(Res.get());
Fariborz Jahanian4239aa12010-07-09 22:21:32 +00001869 Expr *Init = Res.takeAs<Expr>();
1870 BDRE->setCopyConstructorExpr(Init);
1871 }
Fariborz Jahanianea882cd2010-06-04 21:35:44 +00001872 }
1873 }
1874 return Owned(BDRE);
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00001875 }
1876 // If this reference is not in a block or if the referenced variable is
1877 // within the block, create a normal DeclRefExpr.
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00001878
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001879 return BuildDeclRefExpr(VD, VD->getType().getNonReferenceType(),
1880 NameInfo, &SS);
Chris Lattner17ed4872006-11-20 04:58:19 +00001881}
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00001882
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001883ExprResult Sema::ActOnPredefinedExpr(SourceLocation Loc,
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001884 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
Chris Lattner6307f192008-08-10 01:53:14 +00001885 PredefinedExpr::IdentType IT;
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001886
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00001887 switch (Kind) {
Chris Lattner317e6ba2008-01-12 18:39:25 +00001888 default: assert(0 && "Unknown simple primary expr!");
Chris Lattner6307f192008-08-10 01:53:14 +00001889 case tok::kw___func__: IT = PredefinedExpr::Func; break; // [C99 6.4.2.2]
1890 case tok::kw___FUNCTION__: IT = PredefinedExpr::Function; break;
1891 case tok::kw___PRETTY_FUNCTION__: IT = PredefinedExpr::PrettyFunction; break;
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00001892 }
Chris Lattner317e6ba2008-01-12 18:39:25 +00001893
Chris Lattnera81a0272008-01-12 08:14:25 +00001894 // Pre-defined identifiers are of type char[x], where x is the length of the
1895 // string.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001896
Anders Carlsson2fb08242009-09-08 18:24:21 +00001897 Decl *currentDecl = getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl();
Fariborz Jahanian94627442010-07-23 21:53:24 +00001898 if (!currentDecl && getCurBlock())
1899 currentDecl = getCurBlock()->TheDecl;
Anders Carlsson2fb08242009-09-08 18:24:21 +00001900 if (!currentDecl) {
Chris Lattnerf45c5ec2008-12-12 05:05:20 +00001901 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_predef_outside_function);
Anders Carlsson2fb08242009-09-08 18:24:21 +00001902 currentDecl = Context.getTranslationUnitDecl();
Chris Lattnerf45c5ec2008-12-12 05:05:20 +00001903 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001904
Anders Carlsson0b209a82009-09-11 01:22:35 +00001905 QualType ResTy;
1906 if (cast<DeclContext>(currentDecl)->isDependentContext()) {
1907 ResTy = Context.DependentTy;
1908 } else {
Anders Carlsson5bd8d192010-02-11 18:20:28 +00001909 unsigned Length = PredefinedExpr::ComputeName(IT, currentDecl).length();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001910
Anders Carlsson0b209a82009-09-11 01:22:35 +00001911 llvm::APInt LengthI(32, Length + 1);
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00001912 ResTy = Context.CharTy.withConst();
Anders Carlsson0b209a82009-09-11 01:22:35 +00001913 ResTy = Context.getConstantArrayType(ResTy, LengthI, ArrayType::Normal, 0);
1914 }
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00001915 return Owned(new (Context) PredefinedExpr(Loc, ResTy, IT));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00001916}
1917
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001918ExprResult Sema::ActOnCharacterConstant(const Token &Tok) {
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +00001919 llvm::SmallString<16> CharBuffer;
Douglas Gregordc970f02010-03-16 22:30:13 +00001920 bool Invalid = false;
1921 llvm::StringRef ThisTok = PP.getSpelling(Tok, CharBuffer, &Invalid);
1922 if (Invalid)
1923 return ExprError();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001924
Benjamin Kramer0a1abd42010-02-27 13:44:12 +00001925 CharLiteralParser Literal(ThisTok.begin(), ThisTok.end(), Tok.getLocation(),
1926 PP);
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00001927 if (Literal.hadError())
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001928 return ExprError();
Chris Lattneref24b382008-03-01 08:32:21 +00001929
Chris Lattnerc3847ba2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00001930 QualType Ty;
1931 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
1932 Ty = Context.IntTy; // 'x' and L'x' -> int in C.
1933 else if (Literal.isWide())
1934 Ty = Context.WCharTy; // L'x' -> wchar_t in C++.
Eli Friedmaneb1df702010-02-03 18:21:45 +00001935 else if (Literal.isMultiChar())
1936 Ty = Context.IntTy; // 'wxyz' -> int in C++.
Chris Lattnerc3847ba2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00001937 else
1938 Ty = Context.CharTy; // 'x' -> char in C++
Chris Lattneref24b382008-03-01 08:32:21 +00001939
Sebastian Redl20614a72009-01-20 22:23:13 +00001940 return Owned(new (Context) CharacterLiteral(Literal.getValue(),
1941 Literal.isWide(),
Chris Lattnerc3847ba2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00001942 Ty, Tok.getLocation()));
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00001943}
1944
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001945ExprResult Sema::ActOnNumericConstant(const Token &Tok) {
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001946 // Fast path for a single digit (which is quite common). A single digit
Steve Narofff2fb89e2007-03-13 20:29:44 +00001947 // cannot have a trigraph, escaped newline, radix prefix, or type suffix.
1948 if (Tok.getLength() == 1) {
Chris Lattner9240b3e2009-01-26 22:36:52 +00001949 const char Val = PP.getSpellingOfSingleCharacterNumericConstant(Tok);
Chris Lattnerc4c18192009-01-16 07:10:29 +00001950 unsigned IntSize = Context.Target.getIntWidth();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis43b20572010-08-28 09:06:06 +00001951 return Owned(IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, llvm::APInt(IntSize, Val-'0'),
Steve Naroff5faaef72009-01-20 19:53:53 +00001952 Context.IntTy, Tok.getLocation()));
Steve Narofff2fb89e2007-03-13 20:29:44 +00001953 }
Ted Kremeneke9814182009-01-13 23:19:12 +00001954
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +00001955 llvm::SmallString<512> IntegerBuffer;
Chris Lattnera1cf5f92008-09-30 20:53:45 +00001956 // Add padding so that NumericLiteralParser can overread by one character.
1957 IntegerBuffer.resize(Tok.getLength()+1);
Steve Naroff8160ea22007-03-06 01:09:46 +00001958 const char *ThisTokBegin = &IntegerBuffer[0];
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001959
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001960 // Get the spelling of the token, which eliminates trigraphs, etc.
Douglas Gregordc970f02010-03-16 22:30:13 +00001961 bool Invalid = false;
1962 unsigned ActualLength = PP.getSpelling(Tok, ThisTokBegin, &Invalid);
1963 if (Invalid)
1964 return ExprError();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001965
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001966 NumericLiteralParser Literal(ThisTokBegin, ThisTokBegin+ActualLength,
Steve Naroff451d8f162007-03-12 23:22:38 +00001967 Tok.getLocation(), PP);
Steve Narofff2fb89e2007-03-13 20:29:44 +00001968 if (Literal.hadError)
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001969 return ExprError();
1970
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001971 Expr *Res;
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001972
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001973 if (Literal.isFloatingLiteral()) {
Chris Lattnerec0a6d92007-09-22 18:29:59 +00001974 QualType Ty;
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001975 if (Literal.isFloat)
Chris Lattnerec0a6d92007-09-22 18:29:59 +00001976 Ty = Context.FloatTy;
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001977 else if (!Literal.isLong)
Chris Lattnerec0a6d92007-09-22 18:29:59 +00001978 Ty = Context.DoubleTy;
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001979 else
Chris Lattner7570e9c2008-03-08 08:52:55 +00001980 Ty = Context.LongDoubleTy;
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001981
1982 const llvm::fltSemantics &Format = Context.getFloatTypeSemantics(Ty);
1983
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001984 using llvm::APFloat;
1985 APFloat Val(Format);
1986
1987 APFloat::opStatus result = Literal.GetFloatValue(Val);
John McCall122c8312009-12-24 11:09:08 +00001988
1989 // Overflow is always an error, but underflow is only an error if
1990 // we underflowed to zero (APFloat reports denormals as underflow).
1991 if ((result & APFloat::opOverflow) ||
1992 ((result & APFloat::opUnderflow) && Val.isZero())) {
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001993 unsigned diagnostic;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001994 llvm::SmallString<20> buffer;
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001995 if (result & APFloat::opOverflow) {
John McCall62abc942010-02-26 23:35:57 +00001996 diagnostic = diag::warn_float_overflow;
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001997 APFloat::getLargest(Format).toString(buffer);
1998 } else {
John McCall62abc942010-02-26 23:35:57 +00001999 diagnostic = diag::warn_float_underflow;
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00002000 APFloat::getSmallest(Format).toString(buffer);
2001 }
2002
2003 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diagnostic)
2004 << Ty
2005 << llvm::StringRef(buffer.data(), buffer.size());
2006 }
2007
2008 bool isExact = (result == APFloat::opOK);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis43b20572010-08-28 09:06:06 +00002009 Res = FloatingLiteral::Create(Context, Val, isExact, Ty, Tok.getLocation());
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002010
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00002011 } else if (!Literal.isIntegerLiteral()) {
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002012 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00002013 } else {
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002014 QualType Ty;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002015
Neil Boothac582c52007-08-29 22:00:19 +00002016 // long long is a C99 feature.
2017 if (!getLangOptions().C99 && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus0x &&
Neil Booth4a1ee052007-08-29 22:13:52 +00002018 Literal.isLongLong)
Neil Boothac582c52007-08-29 22:00:19 +00002019 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::ext_longlong);
2020
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002021 // Get the value in the widest-possible width.
Chris Lattner37e05872008-03-05 18:54:05 +00002022 llvm::APInt ResultVal(Context.Target.getIntMaxTWidth(), 0);
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002023
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002024 if (Literal.GetIntegerValue(ResultVal)) {
2025 // If this value didn't fit into uintmax_t, warn and force to ull.
2026 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::warn_integer_too_large);
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002027 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
2028 assert(Context.getTypeSize(Ty) == ResultVal.getBitWidth() &&
Chris Lattner37e05872008-03-05 18:54:05 +00002029 "long long is not intmax_t?");
Steve Naroff09ef4742007-03-09 23:16:33 +00002030 } else {
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002031 // If this value fits into a ULL, try to figure out what else it fits into
2032 // according to the rules of C99 6.4.4.1p5.
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002033
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002034 // Octal, Hexadecimal, and integers with a U suffix are allowed to
2035 // be an unsigned int.
2036 bool AllowUnsigned = Literal.isUnsigned || Literal.getRadix() != 10;
2037
2038 // Check from smallest to largest, picking the smallest type we can.
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002039 unsigned Width = 0;
Chris Lattner7b939cf2007-08-23 21:58:08 +00002040 if (!Literal.isLong && !Literal.isLongLong) {
2041 // Are int/unsigned possibilities?
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002042 unsigned IntSize = Context.Target.getIntWidth();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002043
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002044 // Does it fit in a unsigned int?
2045 if (ResultVal.isIntN(IntSize)) {
2046 // Does it fit in a signed int?
2047 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[IntSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002048 Ty = Context.IntTy;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002049 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002050 Ty = Context.UnsignedIntTy;
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002051 Width = IntSize;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002052 }
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002053 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002054
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002055 // Are long/unsigned long possibilities?
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002056 if (Ty.isNull() && !Literal.isLongLong) {
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002057 unsigned LongSize = Context.Target.getLongWidth();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002058
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002059 // Does it fit in a unsigned long?
2060 if (ResultVal.isIntN(LongSize)) {
2061 // Does it fit in a signed long?
2062 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[LongSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002063 Ty = Context.LongTy;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002064 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002065 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongTy;
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002066 Width = LongSize;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002067 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002068 }
2069
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002070 // Finally, check long long if needed.
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002071 if (Ty.isNull()) {
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002072 unsigned LongLongSize = Context.Target.getLongLongWidth();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002073
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002074 // Does it fit in a unsigned long long?
2075 if (ResultVal.isIntN(LongLongSize)) {
2076 // Does it fit in a signed long long?
2077 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[LongLongSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002078 Ty = Context.LongLongTy;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002079 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002080 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002081 Width = LongLongSize;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002082 }
2083 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002084
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002085 // If we still couldn't decide a type, we probably have something that
2086 // does not fit in a signed long long, but has no U suffix.
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002087 if (Ty.isNull()) {
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002088 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::warn_integer_too_large_for_signed);
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002089 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002090 Width = Context.Target.getLongLongWidth();
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002091 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002092
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002093 if (ResultVal.getBitWidth() != Width)
2094 ResultVal.trunc(Width);
Steve Naroff09ef4742007-03-09 23:16:33 +00002095 }
Argyrios Kyrtzidis43b20572010-08-28 09:06:06 +00002096 Res = IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, ResultVal, Ty, Tok.getLocation());
Steve Naroff09ef4742007-03-09 23:16:33 +00002097 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002098
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00002099 // If this is an imaginary literal, create the ImaginaryLiteral wrapper.
2100 if (Literal.isImaginary)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002101 Res = new (Context) ImaginaryLiteral(Res,
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00002102 Context.getComplexType(Res->getType()));
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002103
2104 return Owned(Res);
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002105}
2106
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002107ExprResult Sema::ActOnParenExpr(SourceLocation L,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002108 SourceLocation R, Expr *E) {
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002109 assert((E != 0) && "ActOnParenExpr() missing expr");
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00002110 return Owned(new (Context) ParenExpr(L, R, E));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002111}
2112
Steve Naroff71b59a92007-06-04 22:22:31 +00002113/// The UsualUnaryConversions() function is *not* called by this routine.
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00002114/// See C99 6.3.2.1p[2-4] for more details.
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002115bool Sema::CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(QualType exprType,
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002116 SourceLocation OpLoc,
2117 const SourceRange &ExprRange,
2118 bool isSizeof) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002119 if (exprType->isDependentType())
2120 return false;
2121
Sebastian Redl22e2e5c2009-11-23 17:18:46 +00002122 // C++ [expr.sizeof]p2: "When applied to a reference or a reference type,
2123 // the result is the size of the referenced type."
2124 // C++ [expr.alignof]p3: "When alignof is applied to a reference type, the
2125 // result shall be the alignment of the referenced type."
2126 if (const ReferenceType *Ref = exprType->getAs<ReferenceType>())
2127 exprType = Ref->getPointeeType();
2128
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00002129 // C99 6.5.3.4p1:
John McCall4c98fd82009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002130 if (exprType->isFunctionType()) {
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002131 // alignof(function) is allowed as an extension.
Chris Lattnerb1355b12009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002132 if (isSizeof)
2133 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_sizeof_function_type) << ExprRange;
2134 return false;
2135 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002136
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002137 // Allow sizeof(void)/alignof(void) as an extension.
Chris Lattnerb1355b12009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002138 if (exprType->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00002139 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_sizeof_void_type)
2140 << (isSizeof ? "sizeof" : "__alignof") << ExprRange;
Chris Lattnerb1355b12009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002141 return false;
2142 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002143
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002144 if (RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, exprType,
Douglas Gregor906db8a2009-12-15 16:44:32 +00002145 PDiag(diag::err_sizeof_alignof_incomplete_type)
2146 << int(!isSizeof) << ExprRange))
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002147 return true;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002148
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002149 // Reject sizeof(interface) and sizeof(interface<proto>) in 64-bit mode.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00002150 if (LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI && exprType->isObjCObjectType()) {
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002151 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_nonfragile_interface)
Chris Lattnercd2a8c52009-04-24 22:30:50 +00002152 << exprType << isSizeof << ExprRange;
2153 return true;
Chris Lattner37920f52009-04-21 19:55:16 +00002154 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002155
Douglas Gregor27887822010-05-23 19:43:23 +00002156 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(exprType, Context.OverloadTy)) {
2157 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_overloaded_function_type)
2158 << !isSizeof << ExprRange;
2159 return true;
2160 }
2161
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002162 return false;
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00002163}
2164
Chris Lattner8dff0172009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002165bool Sema::CheckAlignOfExpr(Expr *E, SourceLocation OpLoc,
2166 const SourceRange &ExprRange) {
2167 E = E->IgnoreParens();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002168
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002169 // alignof decl is always ok.
Chris Lattner8dff0172009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002170 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(E))
2171 return false;
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002172
2173 // Cannot know anything else if the expression is dependent.
2174 if (E->isTypeDependent())
2175 return false;
2176
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002177 if (E->getBitField()) {
2178 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_bitfield) << 1 << ExprRange;
2179 return true;
Chris Lattner8dff0172009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002180 }
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002181
2182 // Alignment of a field access is always okay, so long as it isn't a
2183 // bit-field.
2184 if (MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(E))
Mike Stump212005c2009-07-22 18:58:19 +00002185 if (isa<FieldDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl()))
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002186 return false;
2187
Chris Lattner8dff0172009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002188 return CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(E->getType(), OpLoc, ExprRange, false);
2189}
2190
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002191/// \brief Build a sizeof or alignof expression given a type operand.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002192ExprResult
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002193Sema::CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
John McCall4c98fd82009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002194 SourceLocation OpLoc,
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002195 bool isSizeOf, SourceRange R) {
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002196 if (!TInfo)
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002197 return ExprError();
2198
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002199 QualType T = TInfo->getType();
John McCall4c98fd82009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002200
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002201 if (!T->isDependentType() &&
2202 CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(T, OpLoc, R, isSizeOf))
2203 return ExprError();
2204
2205 // C99 6.5.3.4p4: the type (an unsigned integer type) is size_t.
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002206 return Owned(new (Context) SizeOfAlignOfExpr(isSizeOf, TInfo,
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002207 Context.getSizeType(), OpLoc,
2208 R.getEnd()));
2209}
2210
2211/// \brief Build a sizeof or alignof expression given an expression
2212/// operand.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002213ExprResult
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002214Sema::CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(Expr *E, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002215 bool isSizeOf, SourceRange R) {
2216 // Verify that the operand is valid.
2217 bool isInvalid = false;
2218 if (E->isTypeDependent()) {
2219 // Delay type-checking for type-dependent expressions.
2220 } else if (!isSizeOf) {
2221 isInvalid = CheckAlignOfExpr(E, OpLoc, R);
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002222 } else if (E->getBitField()) { // C99 6.5.3.4p1.
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002223 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_bitfield) << 0;
2224 isInvalid = true;
2225 } else {
2226 isInvalid = CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(E->getType(), OpLoc, R, true);
2227 }
2228
2229 if (isInvalid)
2230 return ExprError();
2231
2232 // C99 6.5.3.4p4: the type (an unsigned integer type) is size_t.
2233 return Owned(new (Context) SizeOfAlignOfExpr(isSizeOf, E,
2234 Context.getSizeType(), OpLoc,
2235 R.getEnd()));
2236}
2237
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002238/// ActOnSizeOfAlignOfExpr - Handle @c sizeof(type) and @c sizeof @c expr and
2239/// the same for @c alignof and @c __alignof
2240/// Note that the ArgRange is invalid if isType is false.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002241ExprResult
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002242Sema::ActOnSizeOfAlignOfExpr(SourceLocation OpLoc, bool isSizeof, bool isType,
2243 void *TyOrEx, const SourceRange &ArgRange) {
Chris Lattner0d8b1a12006-11-20 04:34:45 +00002244 // If error parsing type, ignore.
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002245 if (TyOrEx == 0) return ExprError();
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00002246
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002247 if (isType) {
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002248 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
John McCallba7bf592010-08-24 05:47:05 +00002249 (void) GetTypeFromParser(ParsedType::getFromOpaquePtr(TyOrEx), &TInfo);
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002250 return CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(TInfo, OpLoc, isSizeof, ArgRange);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002251 }
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002252
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002253 Expr *ArgEx = (Expr *)TyOrEx;
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002254 ExprResult Result
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002255 = CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(ArgEx, OpLoc, isSizeof, ArgEx->getSourceRange());
2256
2257 if (Result.isInvalid())
2258 DeleteExpr(ArgEx);
2259
2260 return move(Result);
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002261}
2262
Chris Lattner709322b2009-02-17 08:12:06 +00002263QualType Sema::CheckRealImagOperand(Expr *&V, SourceLocation Loc, bool isReal) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002264 if (V->isTypeDependent())
2265 return Context.DependentTy;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002266
Chris Lattnere267f5d2007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002267 // These operators return the element type of a complex type.
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002268 if (const ComplexType *CT = V->getType()->getAs<ComplexType>())
Chris Lattner30b5dd02007-08-24 21:16:53 +00002269 return CT->getElementType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002270
Chris Lattnere267f5d2007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002271 // Otherwise they pass through real integer and floating point types here.
2272 if (V->getType()->isArithmeticType())
2273 return V->getType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002274
Chris Lattnere267f5d2007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002275 // Reject anything else.
Chris Lattner709322b2009-02-17 08:12:06 +00002276 Diag(Loc, diag::err_realimag_invalid_type) << V->getType()
2277 << (isReal ? "__real" : "__imag");
Chris Lattnere267f5d2007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002278 return QualType();
Chris Lattner30b5dd02007-08-24 21:16:53 +00002279}
2280
2281
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002282
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002283ExprResult
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002284Sema::ActOnPostfixUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002285 tok::TokenKind Kind, Expr *Input) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002286 UnaryOperatorKind Opc;
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002287 switch (Kind) {
2288 default: assert(0 && "Unknown unary op!");
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002289 case tok::plusplus: Opc = UO_PostInc; break;
2290 case tok::minusminus: Opc = UO_PostDec; break;
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002291 }
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002292
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002293 return BuildUnaryOp(S, OpLoc, Opc, Input);
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002294}
2295
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002296ExprResult
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002297Sema::ActOnArraySubscriptExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Base, SourceLocation LLoc,
2298 Expr *Idx, SourceLocation RLoc) {
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00002299 // Since this might be a postfix expression, get rid of ParenListExprs.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002300 ExprResult Result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, Base);
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002301 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
2302 Base = Result.take();
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00002303
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002304 Expr *LHSExp = Base, *RHSExp = Idx;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002305
Douglas Gregor40412ac2008-11-19 17:17:41 +00002306 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Douglas Gregor7a77a6b2009-05-19 00:01:19 +00002307 (LHSExp->isTypeDependent() || RHSExp->isTypeDependent())) {
Douglas Gregor7a77a6b2009-05-19 00:01:19 +00002308 return Owned(new (Context) ArraySubscriptExpr(LHSExp, RHSExp,
2309 Context.DependentTy, RLoc));
2310 }
2311
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002312 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002313 (LHSExp->getType()->isRecordType() ||
Eli Friedman254a1a22008-12-15 22:34:21 +00002314 LHSExp->getType()->isEnumeralType() ||
2315 RHSExp->getType()->isRecordType() ||
2316 RHSExp->getType()->isEnumeralType())) {
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002317 return CreateOverloadedArraySubscriptExpr(LLoc, RLoc, Base, Idx);
Douglas Gregor40412ac2008-11-19 17:17:41 +00002318 }
2319
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002320 return CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(Base, LLoc, Idx, RLoc);
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00002321}
2322
2323
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002324ExprResult
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002325Sema::CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(Expr *Base, SourceLocation LLoc,
2326 Expr *Idx, SourceLocation RLoc) {
2327 Expr *LHSExp = Base;
2328 Expr *RHSExp = Idx;
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00002329
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002330 // Perform default conversions.
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00002331 if (!LHSExp->getType()->getAs<VectorType>())
2332 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(LHSExp);
2333 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHSExp);
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002334
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002335 QualType LHSTy = LHSExp->getType(), RHSTy = RHSExp->getType();
Steve Narofff1e53692007-03-23 22:27:02 +00002336
Steve Naroffc1aadb12007-03-28 21:49:40 +00002337 // C99 6.5.2.1p2: the expression e1[e2] is by definition precisely equivalent
Chris Lattnerf17bd422007-08-30 17:45:32 +00002338 // to the expression *((e1)+(e2)). This means the array "Base" may actually be
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002339 // in the subscript position. As a result, we need to derive the array base
Steve Narofff1e53692007-03-23 22:27:02 +00002340 // and index from the expression types.
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002341 Expr *BaseExpr, *IndexExpr;
2342 QualType ResultType;
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002343 if (LHSTy->isDependentType() || RHSTy->isDependentType()) {
2344 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2345 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
2346 ResultType = Context.DependentTy;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002347 } else if (const PointerType *PTy = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002348 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2349 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002350 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002351 } else if (const PointerType *PTy = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Chris Lattneraee0cfd2007-07-16 00:23:25 +00002352 // Handle the uncommon case of "123[Ptr]".
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002353 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2354 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002355 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002356 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy =
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002357 LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002358 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2359 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
2360 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002361 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy =
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002362 RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002363 // Handle the uncommon case of "123[Ptr]".
2364 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2365 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
2366 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002367 } else if (const VectorType *VTy = LHSTy->getAs<VectorType>()) {
Chris Lattner41977962007-07-31 19:29:30 +00002368 BaseExpr = LHSExp; // vectors: V[123]
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002369 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Nate Begemanc1bf0612009-01-18 00:45:31 +00002370
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002371 // FIXME: need to deal with const...
2372 ResultType = VTy->getElementType();
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002373 } else if (LHSTy->isArrayType()) {
2374 // If we see an array that wasn't promoted by
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00002375 // DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion, it must be an array that
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002376 // wasn't promoted because of the C90 rule that doesn't
2377 // allow promoting non-lvalue arrays. Warn, then
2378 // force the promotion here.
2379 Diag(LHSExp->getLocStart(), diag::ext_subscript_non_lvalue) <<
2380 LHSExp->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00002381 ImpCastExprToType(LHSExp, Context.getArrayDecayedType(LHSTy),
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002382 CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002383 LHSTy = LHSExp->getType();
2384
2385 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2386 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002387 ResultType = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002388 } else if (RHSTy->isArrayType()) {
2389 // Same as previous, except for 123[f().a] case
2390 Diag(RHSExp->getLocStart(), diag::ext_subscript_non_lvalue) <<
2391 RHSExp->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00002392 ImpCastExprToType(RHSExp, Context.getArrayDecayedType(RHSTy),
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002393 CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002394 RHSTy = RHSExp->getType();
2395
2396 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2397 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002398 ResultType = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroffb3096442007-06-09 03:47:53 +00002399 } else {
Chris Lattner003af242009-04-25 22:50:55 +00002400 return ExprError(Diag(LLoc, diag::err_typecheck_subscript_value)
2401 << LHSExp->getSourceRange() << RHSExp->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002402 }
Steve Naroffc1aadb12007-03-28 21:49:40 +00002403 // C99 6.5.2.1p1
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00002404 if (!IndexExpr->getType()->isIntegerType() && !IndexExpr->isTypeDependent())
Chris Lattner003af242009-04-25 22:50:55 +00002405 return ExprError(Diag(LLoc, diag::err_typecheck_subscript_not_integer)
2406 << IndexExpr->getSourceRange());
Steve Naroffb29cdd52007-07-10 18:23:31 +00002407
Daniel Dunbar4782a6e2009-09-17 06:31:17 +00002408 if ((IndexExpr->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_S) ||
Sam Weinigb7608d72009-09-14 20:14:57 +00002409 IndexExpr->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_U))
2410 && !IndexExpr->isTypeDependent())
Sam Weinig914244e2009-09-14 01:58:58 +00002411 Diag(LLoc, diag::warn_subscript_is_char) << IndexExpr->getSourceRange();
2412
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002413 // C99 6.5.2.1p1: "shall have type "pointer to *object* type". Similarly,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002414 // C++ [expr.sub]p1: The type "T" shall be a completely-defined object
2415 // type. Note that Functions are not objects, and that (in C99 parlance)
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002416 // incomplete types are not object types.
2417 if (ResultType->isFunctionType()) {
2418 Diag(BaseExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_subscript_function_type)
2419 << ResultType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
2420 return ExprError();
2421 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002422
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002423 if (!ResultType->isDependentType() &&
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002424 RequireCompleteType(LLoc, ResultType,
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00002425 PDiag(diag::err_subscript_incomplete_type)
2426 << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()))
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002427 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002428
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002429 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00002430 if (ResultType->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002431 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_subscript_nonfragile_interface)
2432 << ResultType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
2433 return ExprError();
2434 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002435
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002436 return Owned(new (Context) ArraySubscriptExpr(LHSExp, RHSExp,
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00002437 ResultType, RLoc));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002438}
2439
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002440QualType Sema::
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002441CheckExtVectorComponent(QualType baseType, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002442 const IdentifierInfo *CompName,
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002443 SourceLocation CompLoc) {
Daniel Dunbarc0429402009-10-18 02:09:38 +00002444 // FIXME: Share logic with ExtVectorElementExpr::containsDuplicateElements,
2445 // see FIXME there.
2446 //
2447 // FIXME: This logic can be greatly simplified by splitting it along
2448 // halving/not halving and reworking the component checking.
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002449 const ExtVectorType *vecType = baseType->getAs<ExtVectorType>();
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002450
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002451 // The vector accessor can't exceed the number of elements.
Daniel Dunbar2c422dc92009-10-18 20:26:12 +00002452 const char *compStr = CompName->getNameStart();
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002453
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002454 // This flag determines whether or not the component is one of the four
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002455 // special names that indicate a subset of exactly half the elements are
2456 // to be selected.
2457 bool HalvingSwizzle = false;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002458
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002459 // This flag determines whether or not CompName has an 's' char prefix,
2460 // indicating that it is a string of hex values to be used as vector indices.
Nate Begeman0359e122009-06-25 21:06:09 +00002461 bool HexSwizzle = *compStr == 's' || *compStr == 'S';
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002462
2463 // Check that we've found one of the special components, or that the component
2464 // names must come from the same set.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002465 if (!strcmp(compStr, "hi") || !strcmp(compStr, "lo") ||
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002466 !strcmp(compStr, "even") || !strcmp(compStr, "odd")) {
2467 HalvingSwizzle = true;
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002468 } else if (vecType->getPointAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1) {
Chris Lattner7e152db2007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002469 do
2470 compStr++;
2471 while (*compStr && vecType->getPointAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1);
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002472 } else if (HexSwizzle || vecType->getNumericAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1) {
Chris Lattner7e152db2007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002473 do
2474 compStr++;
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002475 while (*compStr && vecType->getNumericAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1);
Chris Lattner7e152db2007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002476 }
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002477
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002478 if (!HalvingSwizzle && *compStr) {
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002479 // We didn't get to the end of the string. This means the component names
2480 // didn't come from the same set *or* we encountered an illegal name.
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00002481 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ext_vector_component_name_illegal)
Benjamin Kramere8394df2010-08-11 14:47:12 +00002482 << llvm::StringRef(compStr, 1) << SourceRange(CompLoc);
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002483 return QualType();
2484 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002485
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002486 // Ensure no component accessor exceeds the width of the vector type it
2487 // operates on.
2488 if (!HalvingSwizzle) {
Daniel Dunbar2c422dc92009-10-18 20:26:12 +00002489 compStr = CompName->getNameStart();
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002490
2491 if (HexSwizzle)
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002492 compStr++;
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002493
2494 while (*compStr) {
2495 if (!vecType->isAccessorWithinNumElements(*compStr++)) {
2496 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ext_vector_component_exceeds_length)
2497 << baseType << SourceRange(CompLoc);
2498 return QualType();
2499 }
2500 }
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002501 }
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002502
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002503 // The component accessor looks fine - now we need to compute the actual type.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002504 // The vector type is implied by the component accessor. For example,
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002505 // vec4.b is a float, vec4.xy is a vec2, vec4.rgb is a vec3, etc.
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002506 // vec4.s0 is a float, vec4.s23 is a vec3, etc.
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002507 // vec4.hi, vec4.lo, vec4.e, and vec4.o all return vec2.
Nate Begemanac8183a2009-12-15 18:13:04 +00002508 unsigned CompSize = HalvingSwizzle ? (vecType->getNumElements() + 1) / 2
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002509 : CompName->getLength();
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002510 if (HexSwizzle)
2511 CompSize--;
2512
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002513 if (CompSize == 1)
2514 return vecType->getElementType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002515
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002516 QualType VT = Context.getExtVectorType(vecType->getElementType(), CompSize);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002517 // Now look up the TypeDefDecl from the vector type. Without this,
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002518 // diagostics look bad. We want extended vector types to appear built-in.
2519 for (unsigned i = 0, E = ExtVectorDecls.size(); i != E; ++i) {
2520 if (ExtVectorDecls[i]->getUnderlyingType() == VT)
2521 return Context.getTypedefType(ExtVectorDecls[i]);
Steve Naroffddf5a1d2007-07-29 16:33:31 +00002522 }
2523 return VT; // should never get here (a typedef type should always be found).
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002524}
2525
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002526static Decl *FindGetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(const ObjCProtocolDecl*PDecl,
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002527 IdentifierInfo *Member,
Douglas Gregorbcced4e2009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002528 const Selector &Sel,
2529 ASTContext &Context) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002530
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002531 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = PDecl->FindPropertyDeclaration(Member))
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002532 return PD;
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscfbfe782009-06-30 02:36:12 +00002533 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = PDecl->getInstanceMethod(Sel))
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002534 return OMD;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002535
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002536 for (ObjCProtocolDecl::protocol_iterator I = PDecl->protocol_begin(),
2537 E = PDecl->protocol_end(); I != E; ++I) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002538 if (Decl *D = FindGetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(*I, Member, Sel,
Douglas Gregorbcced4e2009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002539 Context))
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002540 return D;
2541 }
2542 return 0;
2543}
2544
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00002545static Decl *FindGetterNameDecl(const ObjCObjectPointerType *QIdTy,
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002546 IdentifierInfo *Member,
Douglas Gregorbcced4e2009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002547 const Selector &Sel,
2548 ASTContext &Context) {
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002549 // Check protocols on qualified interfaces.
2550 Decl *GDecl = 0;
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00002551 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator I = QIdTy->qual_begin(),
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002552 E = QIdTy->qual_end(); I != E; ++I) {
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002553 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = (*I)->FindPropertyDeclaration(Member)) {
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002554 GDecl = PD;
2555 break;
2556 }
2557 // Also must look for a getter name which uses property syntax.
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscfbfe782009-06-30 02:36:12 +00002558 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = (*I)->getInstanceMethod(Sel)) {
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002559 GDecl = OMD;
2560 break;
2561 }
2562 }
2563 if (!GDecl) {
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00002564 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator I = QIdTy->qual_begin(),
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002565 E = QIdTy->qual_end(); I != E; ++I) {
2566 // Search in the protocol-qualifier list of current protocol.
Douglas Gregorbcced4e2009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002567 GDecl = FindGetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(*I, Member, Sel, Context);
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002568 if (GDecl)
2569 return GDecl;
2570 }
2571 }
2572 return GDecl;
2573}
Chris Lattner4bf74fd2009-02-15 22:43:40 +00002574
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002575ExprResult
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002576Sema::ActOnDependentMemberExpr(Expr *BaseExpr, QualType BaseType,
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002577 bool IsArrow, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002578 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
2579 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002580 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002581 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002582 // Even in dependent contexts, try to diagnose base expressions with
2583 // obviously wrong types, e.g.:
2584 //
2585 // T* t;
2586 // t.f;
2587 //
2588 // In Obj-C++, however, the above expression is valid, since it could be
2589 // accessing the 'f' property if T is an Obj-C interface. The extra check
2590 // allows this, while still reporting an error if T is a struct pointer.
2591 if (!IsArrow) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002592 const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002593 if (PT && (!getLangOptions().ObjC1 ||
2594 PT->getPointeeType()->isRecordType())) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002595 assert(BaseExpr && "cannot happen with implicit member accesses");
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002596 Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(), diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_struct_union)
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002597 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002598 return ExprError();
2599 }
2600 }
2601
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002602 assert(BaseType->isDependentType() ||
2603 NameInfo.getName().isDependentName() ||
Douglas Gregor41f90302010-04-12 20:54:26 +00002604 isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS));
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002605
2606 // Get the type being accessed in BaseType. If this is an arrow, the BaseExpr
2607 // must have pointer type, and the accessed type is the pointee.
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002608 return Owned(CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr::Create(Context, BaseExpr, BaseType,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002609 IsArrow, OpLoc,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002610 SS.getScopeRep(),
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002611 SS.getRange(),
2612 FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002613 NameInfo, TemplateArgs));
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002614}
2615
2616/// We know that the given qualified member reference points only to
2617/// declarations which do not belong to the static type of the base
2618/// expression. Diagnose the problem.
2619static void DiagnoseQualifiedMemberReference(Sema &SemaRef,
2620 Expr *BaseExpr,
2621 QualType BaseType,
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002622 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002623 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002624 // If this is an implicit member access, use a different set of
2625 // diagnostics.
2626 if (!BaseExpr)
2627 return DiagnoseInstanceReference(SemaRef, SS, R);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002628
John McCall1e67dd62010-04-27 01:43:38 +00002629 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_qualified_member_of_unrelated)
2630 << SS.getRange() << R.getRepresentativeDecl() << BaseType;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002631}
2632
2633// Check whether the declarations we found through a nested-name
2634// specifier in a member expression are actually members of the base
2635// type. The restriction here is:
2636//
2637// C++ [expr.ref]p2:
2638// ... In these cases, the id-expression shall name a
2639// member of the class or of one of its base classes.
2640//
2641// So it's perfectly legitimate for the nested-name specifier to name
2642// an unrelated class, and for us to find an overload set including
2643// decls from classes which are not superclasses, as long as the decl
2644// we actually pick through overload resolution is from a superclass.
2645bool Sema::CheckQualifiedMemberReference(Expr *BaseExpr,
2646 QualType BaseType,
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002647 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002648 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002649 const RecordType *BaseRT = BaseType->getAs<RecordType>();
2650 if (!BaseRT) {
2651 // We can't check this yet because the base type is still
2652 // dependent.
2653 assert(BaseType->isDependentType());
2654 return false;
2655 }
2656 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002657
2658 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002659 // If this is an implicit member reference and we find a
2660 // non-instance member, it's not an error.
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002661 if (!BaseExpr && !(*I)->isCXXInstanceMember())
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002662 return false;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002663
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002664 // Note that we use the DC of the decl, not the underlying decl.
Eli Friedman75300492010-07-27 20:51:02 +00002665 DeclContext *DC = (*I)->getDeclContext();
2666 while (DC->isTransparentContext())
2667 DC = DC->getParent();
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002668
Douglas Gregora9c3e822010-07-28 22:27:52 +00002669 if (!DC->isRecord())
2670 continue;
2671
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002672 llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*,4> MemberRecord;
Eli Friedman75300492010-07-27 20:51:02 +00002673 MemberRecord.insert(cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)->getCanonicalDecl());
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002674
2675 if (!IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(*this, BaseRecord, MemberRecord))
2676 return false;
2677 }
2678
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002679 DiagnoseQualifiedMemberReference(*this, BaseExpr, BaseType, SS, R);
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002680 return true;
2681}
2682
2683static bool
2684LookupMemberExprInRecord(Sema &SemaRef, LookupResult &R,
2685 SourceRange BaseRange, const RecordType *RTy,
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00002686 SourceLocation OpLoc, CXXScopeSpec &SS,
2687 bool HasTemplateArgs) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002688 RecordDecl *RDecl = RTy->getDecl();
2689 if (SemaRef.RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, QualType(RTy, 0),
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00002690 SemaRef.PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_tag)
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002691 << BaseRange))
2692 return true;
2693
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00002694 if (HasTemplateArgs) {
2695 // LookupTemplateName doesn't expect these both to exist simultaneously.
2696 QualType ObjectType = SS.isSet() ? QualType() : QualType(RTy, 0);
2697
2698 bool MOUS;
2699 SemaRef.LookupTemplateName(R, 0, SS, ObjectType, false, MOUS);
2700 return false;
2701 }
2702
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002703 DeclContext *DC = RDecl;
2704 if (SS.isSet()) {
2705 // If the member name was a qualified-id, look into the
2706 // nested-name-specifier.
2707 DC = SemaRef.computeDeclContext(SS, false);
2708
John McCall0b66eb32010-05-01 00:40:08 +00002709 if (SemaRef.RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC)) {
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002710 SemaRef.Diag(SS.getRange().getEnd(), diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_tag)
2711 << SS.getRange() << DC;
2712 return true;
2713 }
2714
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002715 assert(DC && "Cannot handle non-computable dependent contexts in lookup");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002716
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002717 if (!isa<TypeDecl>(DC)) {
2718 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_qualified_member_nonclass)
2719 << DC << SS.getRange();
2720 return true;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002721 }
2722 }
2723
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002724 // The record definition is complete, now look up the member.
2725 SemaRef.LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002726
Douglas Gregoraf2bd472009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002727 if (!R.empty())
2728 return false;
2729
2730 // We didn't find anything with the given name, so try to correct
2731 // for typos.
2732 DeclarationName Name = R.getLookupName();
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00002733 if (SemaRef.CorrectTypo(R, 0, &SS, DC, false, Sema::CTC_MemberLookup) &&
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +00002734 !R.empty() &&
Douglas Gregoraf2bd472009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002735 (isa<ValueDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*R.begin()))) {
2736 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
2737 << Name << DC << R.getLookupName() << SS.getRange()
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00002738 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
2739 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
Douglas Gregor6da83622010-01-07 00:17:44 +00002740 if (NamedDecl *ND = R.getAsSingle<NamedDecl>())
2741 SemaRef.Diag(ND->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
2742 << ND->getDeclName();
Douglas Gregoraf2bd472009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002743 return false;
2744 } else {
2745 R.clear();
Douglas Gregorc048c522010-06-29 19:27:42 +00002746 R.setLookupName(Name);
Douglas Gregoraf2bd472009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002747 }
2748
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002749 return false;
2750}
2751
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002752ExprResult
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002753Sema::BuildMemberReferenceExpr(Expr *Base, QualType BaseType,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002754 SourceLocation OpLoc, bool IsArrow,
Jeffrey Yasskinc76498d2010-04-08 16:38:48 +00002755 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002756 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002757 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002758 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002759 if (BaseType->isDependentType() ||
2760 (SS.isSet() && isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS)))
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002761 return ActOnDependentMemberExpr(Base, BaseType,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002762 IsArrow, OpLoc,
2763 SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002764 NameInfo, TemplateArgs);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002765
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002766 LookupResult R(*this, NameInfo, LookupMemberName);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002767
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002768 // Implicit member accesses.
2769 if (!Base) {
2770 QualType RecordTy = BaseType;
2771 if (IsArrow) RecordTy = RecordTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
2772 if (LookupMemberExprInRecord(*this, R, SourceRange(),
2773 RecordTy->getAs<RecordType>(),
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00002774 OpLoc, SS, TemplateArgs != 0))
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002775 return ExprError();
2776
2777 // Explicit member accesses.
2778 } else {
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002779 ExprResult Result =
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002780 LookupMemberExpr(R, Base, IsArrow, OpLoc,
John McCall48871652010-08-21 09:40:31 +00002781 SS, /*ObjCImpDecl*/ 0, TemplateArgs != 0);
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002782
2783 if (Result.isInvalid()) {
2784 Owned(Base);
2785 return ExprError();
2786 }
2787
2788 if (Result.get())
2789 return move(Result);
Sebastian Redlfa1f70f2010-05-07 09:25:11 +00002790
2791 // LookupMemberExpr can modify Base, and thus change BaseType
2792 BaseType = Base->getType();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002793 }
2794
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002795 return BuildMemberReferenceExpr(Base, BaseType,
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002796 OpLoc, IsArrow, SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
2797 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002798}
2799
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002800ExprResult
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002801Sema::BuildMemberReferenceExpr(Expr *BaseExpr, QualType BaseExprType,
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002802 SourceLocation OpLoc, bool IsArrow,
2803 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002804 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002805 LookupResult &R,
Douglas Gregorb139cd52010-05-01 20:49:11 +00002806 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs,
2807 bool SuppressQualifierCheck) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002808 QualType BaseType = BaseExprType;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002809 if (IsArrow) {
2810 assert(BaseType->isPointerType());
2811 BaseType = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
2812 }
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002813 R.setBaseObjectType(BaseType);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002814
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002815 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier = SS.getScopeRep();
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002816 const DeclarationNameInfo &MemberNameInfo = R.getLookupNameInfo();
2817 DeclarationName MemberName = MemberNameInfo.getName();
2818 SourceLocation MemberLoc = MemberNameInfo.getLoc();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002819
2820 if (R.isAmbiguous())
Douglas Gregord8061562009-08-06 03:17:00 +00002821 return ExprError();
2822
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002823 if (R.empty()) {
2824 // Rederive where we looked up.
2825 DeclContext *DC = (SS.isSet()
2826 ? computeDeclContext(SS, false)
2827 : BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl());
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00002828
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002829 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002830 << MemberName << DC
2831 << (BaseExpr ? BaseExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange());
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002832 return ExprError();
2833 }
2834
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002835 // Diagnose lookups that find only declarations from a non-base
2836 // type. This is possible for either qualified lookups (which may
2837 // have been qualified with an unrelated type) or implicit member
2838 // expressions (which were found with unqualified lookup and thus
2839 // may have come from an enclosing scope). Note that it's okay for
2840 // lookup to find declarations from a non-base type as long as those
2841 // aren't the ones picked by overload resolution.
2842 if ((SS.isSet() || !BaseExpr ||
2843 (isa<CXXThisExpr>(BaseExpr) &&
2844 cast<CXXThisExpr>(BaseExpr)->isImplicit())) &&
Douglas Gregorb139cd52010-05-01 20:49:11 +00002845 !SuppressQualifierCheck &&
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002846 CheckQualifiedMemberReference(BaseExpr, BaseType, SS, R))
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002847 return ExprError();
2848
2849 // Construct an unresolved result if we in fact got an unresolved
2850 // result.
2851 if (R.isOverloadedResult() || R.isUnresolvableResult()) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002852 bool Dependent =
John McCall71739032009-12-19 02:05:44 +00002853 BaseExprType->isDependentType() ||
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002854 R.isUnresolvableResult() ||
John McCall1acbbb52010-02-02 06:20:04 +00002855 OverloadExpr::ComputeDependence(R.begin(), R.end(), TemplateArgs);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002856
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00002857 // Suppress any lookup-related diagnostics; we'll do these when we
2858 // pick a member.
2859 R.suppressDiagnostics();
2860
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002861 UnresolvedMemberExpr *MemExpr
2862 = UnresolvedMemberExpr::Create(Context, Dependent,
2863 R.isUnresolvableResult(),
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002864 BaseExpr, BaseExprType,
2865 IsArrow, OpLoc,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002866 Qualifier, SS.getRange(),
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002867 MemberNameInfo,
Douglas Gregor30a4f4c2010-05-23 18:57:34 +00002868 TemplateArgs, R.begin(), R.end());
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002869
2870 return Owned(MemExpr);
2871 }
2872
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002873 assert(R.isSingleResult());
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002874 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = R.begin().getPair();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002875 NamedDecl *MemberDecl = R.getFoundDecl();
2876
2877 // FIXME: diagnose the presence of template arguments now.
2878
2879 // If the decl being referenced had an error, return an error for this
2880 // sub-expr without emitting another error, in order to avoid cascading
2881 // error cases.
2882 if (MemberDecl->isInvalidDecl())
2883 return ExprError();
2884
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002885 // Handle the implicit-member-access case.
2886 if (!BaseExpr) {
2887 // If this is not an instance member, convert to a non-member access.
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002888 if (!MemberDecl->isCXXInstanceMember())
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002889 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R.getLookupNameInfo(), MemberDecl);
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002890
Douglas Gregorb15af892010-01-07 23:12:05 +00002891 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
2892 if (SS.getRange().isValid())
2893 Loc = SS.getRange().getBegin();
2894 BaseExpr = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc, BaseExprType,/*isImplicit=*/true);
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002895 }
2896
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002897 bool ShouldCheckUse = true;
2898 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2899 // Don't diagnose the use of a virtual member function unless it's
2900 // explicitly qualified.
2901 if (MD->isVirtual() && !SS.isSet())
2902 ShouldCheckUse = false;
2903 }
2904
2905 // Check the use of this member.
2906 if (ShouldCheckUse && DiagnoseUseOfDecl(MemberDecl, MemberLoc)) {
2907 Owned(BaseExpr);
2908 return ExprError();
2909 }
2910
2911 if (FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2912 // We may have found a field within an anonymous union or struct
2913 // (C++ [class.union]).
Eli Friedman78cde142009-12-04 07:18:51 +00002914 if (cast<RecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion() &&
2915 !BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl()->isAnonymousStructOrUnion())
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002916 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(MemberLoc, FD,
2917 BaseExpr, OpLoc);
2918
2919 // Figure out the type of the member; see C99 6.5.2.3p3, C++ [expr.ref]
2920 QualType MemberType = FD->getType();
2921 if (const ReferenceType *Ref = MemberType->getAs<ReferenceType>())
2922 MemberType = Ref->getPointeeType();
2923 else {
2924 Qualifiers BaseQuals = BaseType.getQualifiers();
2925 BaseQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
2926 if (FD->isMutable()) BaseQuals.removeConst();
2927
2928 Qualifiers MemberQuals
2929 = Context.getCanonicalType(MemberType).getQualifiers();
2930
2931 Qualifiers Combined = BaseQuals + MemberQuals;
2932 if (Combined != MemberQuals)
2933 MemberType = Context.getQualifiedType(MemberType, Combined);
2934 }
2935
2936 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, FD);
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002937 if (PerformObjectMemberConversion(BaseExpr, Qualifier, FoundDecl, FD))
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002938 return ExprError();
2939 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002940 FD, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
2941 MemberType));
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002942 }
2943
2944 if (VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2945 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, Var);
2946 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002947 Var, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002948 Var->getType().getNonReferenceType()));
2949 }
2950
2951 if (FunctionDecl *MemberFn = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2952 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, MemberDecl);
2953 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002954 MemberFn, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002955 MemberFn->getType()));
2956 }
2957
2958 if (EnumConstantDecl *Enum = dyn_cast<EnumConstantDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2959 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, MemberDecl);
2960 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002961 Enum, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
2962 Enum->getType()));
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002963 }
2964
2965 Owned(BaseExpr);
2966
Douglas Gregor861eb802010-04-25 20:55:08 +00002967 // We found something that we didn't expect. Complain.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002968 if (isa<TypeDecl>(MemberDecl))
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002969 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_type)
Douglas Gregor861eb802010-04-25 20:55:08 +00002970 << MemberName << BaseType << int(IsArrow);
2971 else
2972 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_unknown)
2973 << MemberName << BaseType << int(IsArrow);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002974
Douglas Gregor861eb802010-04-25 20:55:08 +00002975 Diag(MemberDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_member_declared_here)
2976 << MemberName;
Douglas Gregor516d6722010-04-25 21:15:30 +00002977 R.suppressDiagnostics();
Douglas Gregor861eb802010-04-25 20:55:08 +00002978 return ExprError();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002979}
2980
2981/// Look up the given member of the given non-type-dependent
2982/// expression. This can return in one of two ways:
2983/// * If it returns a sentinel null-but-valid result, the caller will
2984/// assume that lookup was performed and the results written into
2985/// the provided structure. It will take over from there.
2986/// * Otherwise, the returned expression will be produced in place of
2987/// an ordinary member expression.
2988///
2989/// The ObjCImpDecl bit is a gross hack that will need to be properly
2990/// fixed for ObjC++.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002991ExprResult
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002992Sema::LookupMemberExpr(LookupResult &R, Expr *&BaseExpr,
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00002993 bool &IsArrow, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Jeffrey Yasskinc76498d2010-04-08 16:38:48 +00002994 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall48871652010-08-21 09:40:31 +00002995 Decl *ObjCImpDecl, bool HasTemplateArgs) {
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00002996 assert(BaseExpr && "no base expression");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002997
Steve Naroffeaaae462007-12-16 21:42:28 +00002998 // Perform default conversions.
2999 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(BaseExpr);
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003000
Steve Naroff185616f2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00003001 QualType BaseType = BaseExpr->getType();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003002 assert(!BaseType->isDependentType());
3003
3004 DeclarationName MemberName = R.getLookupName();
3005 SourceLocation MemberLoc = R.getNameLoc();
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003006
3007 // If the user is trying to apply -> or . to a function pointer
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003008 // type, it's probably because they forgot parentheses to call that
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003009 // function. Suggest the addition of those parentheses, build the
3010 // call, and continue on.
3011 if (const PointerType *Ptr = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
3012 if (const FunctionProtoType *Fun
3013 = Ptr->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
3014 QualType ResultTy = Fun->getResultType();
3015 if (Fun->getNumArgs() == 0 &&
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003016 ((!IsArrow && ResultTy->isRecordType()) ||
3017 (IsArrow && ResultTy->isPointerType() &&
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003018 ResultTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()
3019 ->isRecordType()))) {
3020 SourceLocation Loc = PP.getLocForEndOfToken(BaseExpr->getLocEnd());
3021 Diag(Loc, diag::err_member_reference_needs_call)
3022 << QualType(Fun, 0)
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003023 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Loc, "()");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003024
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003025 ExprResult NewBase
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003026 = ActOnCallExpr(0, BaseExpr, Loc,
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003027 MultiExprArg(*this, 0, 0), 0, Loc);
Douglas Gregor143d3672010-06-21 22:46:46 +00003028 BaseExpr = 0;
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003029 if (NewBase.isInvalid())
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003030 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003031
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003032 BaseExpr = NewBase.takeAs<Expr>();
3033 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(BaseExpr);
3034 BaseType = BaseExpr->getType();
3035 }
3036 }
3037 }
3038
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00003039 // If this is an Objective-C pseudo-builtin and a definition is provided then
3040 // use that.
3041 if (BaseType->isObjCIdType()) {
Fariborz Jahanianc2949f92009-12-07 20:09:25 +00003042 if (IsArrow) {
3043 // Handle the following exceptional case PObj->isa.
3044 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
3045 BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003046 if (OPT->getObjectType()->isObjCId() &&
Fariborz Jahanianc2949f92009-12-07 20:09:25 +00003047 MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo()->isStr("isa"))
Fariborz Jahaniana5fee262009-12-09 19:05:56 +00003048 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIsaExpr(BaseExpr, true, MemberLoc,
3049 Context.getObjCClassType()));
Fariborz Jahanianc2949f92009-12-07 20:09:25 +00003050 }
3051 }
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00003052 // We have an 'id' type. Rather than fall through, we check if this
3053 // is a reference to 'isa'.
3054 if (BaseType != Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType) {
3055 BaseType = Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003056 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CK_BitCast);
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00003057 }
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00003058 }
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003059
Fariborz Jahanian04b258c2009-11-25 23:07:42 +00003060 // If this is an Objective-C pseudo-builtin and a definition is provided then
3061 // use that.
3062 if (Context.isObjCSelType(BaseType)) {
3063 // We have an 'SEL' type. Rather than fall through, we check if this
3064 // is a reference to 'sel_id'.
3065 if (BaseType != Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType) {
3066 BaseType = Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003067 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanian04b258c2009-11-25 23:07:42 +00003068 }
3069 }
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003070
Steve Naroff185616f2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00003071 assert(!BaseType.isNull() && "no type for member expression");
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003072
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003073 // Handle properties on ObjC 'Class' types.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003074 if (!IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCClassType()) {
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003075 // Also must look for a getter name which uses property syntax.
3076 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
3077 Selector Sel = PP.getSelectorTable().getNullarySelector(Member);
3078 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = getCurMethodDecl()) {
3079 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = MD->getClassInterface();
3080 ObjCMethodDecl *Getter;
3081 // FIXME: need to also look locally in the implementation.
3082 if ((Getter = IFace->lookupClassMethod(Sel))) {
3083 // Check the use of this method.
3084 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Getter, MemberLoc))
3085 return ExprError();
3086 }
3087 // If we found a getter then this may be a valid dot-reference, we
3088 // will look for the matching setter, in case it is needed.
3089 Selector SetterSel =
3090 SelectorTable::constructSetterName(PP.getIdentifierTable(),
3091 PP.getSelectorTable(), Member);
3092 ObjCMethodDecl *Setter = IFace->lookupClassMethod(SetterSel);
3093 if (!Setter) {
3094 // If this reference is in an @implementation, also check for 'private'
3095 // methods.
Steve Naroffbb69c942009-10-01 23:46:04 +00003096 Setter = IFace->lookupPrivateInstanceMethod(SetterSel);
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003097 }
3098 // Look through local category implementations associated with the class.
3099 if (!Setter)
3100 Setter = IFace->getCategoryClassMethod(SetterSel);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003101
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003102 if (Setter && DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Setter, MemberLoc))
3103 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003104
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003105 if (Getter || Setter) {
3106 QualType PType;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003107
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003108 if (Getter)
Douglas Gregor603d81b2010-07-13 08:18:22 +00003109 PType = Getter->getSendResultType();
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003110 else
3111 // Get the expression type from Setter's incoming parameter.
3112 PType = (*(Setter->param_end() -1))->getType();
3113 // FIXME: we must check that the setter has property type.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003114 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr(Getter,
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003115 PType,
3116 Setter, MemberLoc, BaseExpr));
3117 }
3118 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_property_not_found)
3119 << MemberName << BaseType);
3120 }
3121 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003122
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003123 if (BaseType->isObjCClassType() &&
3124 BaseType != Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType) {
3125 BaseType = Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003126 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003127 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003128
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003129 if (IsArrow) {
3130 if (const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>())
Steve Naroff185616f2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00003131 BaseType = PT->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003132 else if (BaseType->isObjCObjectPointerType())
3133 ;
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003134 else if (BaseType->isRecordType()) {
3135 // Recover from arrow accesses to records, e.g.:
3136 // struct MyRecord foo;
3137 // foo->bar
3138 // This is actually well-formed in C++ if MyRecord has an
3139 // overloaded operator->, but that should have been dealt with
3140 // by now.
3141 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_suggestion)
3142 << BaseType << int(IsArrow) << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003143 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(OpLoc, ".");
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003144 IsArrow = false;
3145 } else {
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003146 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_arrow)
3147 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
3148 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson524d5a42009-05-16 20:31:20 +00003149 }
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003150 } else {
3151 // Recover from dot accesses to pointers, e.g.:
3152 // type *foo;
3153 // foo.bar
3154 // This is actually well-formed in two cases:
3155 // - 'type' is an Objective C type
3156 // - 'bar' is a pseudo-destructor name which happens to refer to
3157 // the appropriate pointer type
3158 if (MemberName.getNameKind() != DeclarationName::CXXDestructorName) {
3159 const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>();
3160 if (PT && PT->getPointeeType()->isRecordType()) {
3161 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_suggestion)
3162 << BaseType << int(IsArrow) << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003163 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(OpLoc, "->");
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003164 BaseType = PT->getPointeeType();
3165 IsArrow = true;
3166 }
3167 }
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003168 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003169
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003170 // Handle field access to simple records.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003171 if (const RecordType *RTy = BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003172 if (LookupMemberExprInRecord(*this, R, BaseExpr->getSourceRange(),
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003173 RTy, OpLoc, SS, HasTemplateArgs))
Douglas Gregordd430f72009-01-19 19:26:10 +00003174 return ExprError();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003175 return Owned((Expr*) 0);
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003176 }
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003177
Chris Lattnerdc420f42008-07-21 04:59:05 +00003178 // Handle access to Objective-C instance variables, such as "Obj->ivar" and
3179 // (*Obj).ivar.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003180 if ((IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) ||
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003181 (!IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCObjectType())) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003182 const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT = BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003183 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl =
3184 OPT ? OPT->getInterfaceDecl()
3185 : BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectType>()->getInterface();
3186 if (IDecl) {
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003187 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
3188
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003189 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003190 ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IDecl->lookupInstanceVariable(Member, ClassDeclared);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003191
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003192 if (!IV) {
3193 // Attempt to correct for typos in ivar names.
3194 LookupResult Res(*this, R.getLookupName(), R.getNameLoc(),
3195 LookupMemberName);
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +00003196 if (CorrectTypo(Res, 0, 0, IDecl, false, CTC_MemberLookup) &&
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003197 (IV = Res.getAsSingle<ObjCIvarDecl>())) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003198 Diag(R.getNameLoc(),
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003199 diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_ivar_suggest)
3200 << IDecl->getDeclName() << MemberName << IV->getDeclName()
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003201 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
3202 IV->getNameAsString());
Douglas Gregor6da83622010-01-07 00:17:44 +00003203 Diag(IV->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003204 << IV->getDeclName();
Douglas Gregorc048c522010-06-29 19:27:42 +00003205 } else {
3206 Res.clear();
3207 Res.setLookupName(Member);
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003208 }
3209 }
3210
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003211 if (IV) {
3212 // If the decl being referenced had an error, return an error for this
3213 // sub-expr without emitting another error, in order to avoid cascading
3214 // error cases.
3215 if (IV->isInvalidDecl())
3216 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00003217
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003218 // Check whether we can reference this field.
3219 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(IV, MemberLoc))
3220 return ExprError();
3221 if (IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Public &&
3222 IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Package) {
3223 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassOfMethodDecl = 0;
3224 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = getCurMethodDecl())
3225 ClassOfMethodDecl = MD->getClassInterface();
3226 else if (ObjCImpDecl && getCurFunctionDecl()) {
3227 // Case of a c-function declared inside an objc implementation.
3228 // FIXME: For a c-style function nested inside an objc implementation
3229 // class, there is no implementation context available, so we pass
3230 // down the context as argument to this routine. Ideally, this context
3231 // need be passed down in the AST node and somehow calculated from the
3232 // AST for a function decl.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003233 if (ObjCImplementationDecl *IMPD =
John McCall48871652010-08-21 09:40:31 +00003234 dyn_cast<ObjCImplementationDecl>(ObjCImpDecl))
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003235 ClassOfMethodDecl = IMPD->getClassInterface();
3236 else if (ObjCCategoryImplDecl* CatImplClass =
John McCall48871652010-08-21 09:40:31 +00003237 dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryImplDecl>(ObjCImpDecl))
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003238 ClassOfMethodDecl = CatImplClass->getClassInterface();
3239 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003240
3241 if (IV->getAccessControl() == ObjCIvarDecl::Private) {
3242 if (ClassDeclared != IDecl ||
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003243 ClassOfMethodDecl != ClassDeclared)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003244 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::error_private_ivar_access)
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003245 << IV->getDeclName();
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00003246 } else if (!IDecl->isSuperClassOf(ClassOfMethodDecl))
3247 // @protected
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003248 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::error_protected_ivar_access)
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003249 << IV->getDeclName();
Steve Naroffd1b64be2009-03-04 18:34:24 +00003250 }
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003251
3252 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIvarRefExpr(IV, IV->getType(),
3253 MemberLoc, BaseExpr,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003254 IsArrow));
Fariborz Jahaniana458c4f2009-03-03 01:21:12 +00003255 }
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003256 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_ivar)
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003257 << IDecl->getDeclName() << MemberName
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003258 << BaseExpr->getSourceRange());
Fariborz Jahanianb1378f92008-12-13 22:20:28 +00003259 }
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003260 }
Steve Naroff1329fa02009-07-15 18:40:39 +00003261 // Handle properties on 'id' and qualified "id".
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003262 if (!IsArrow && (BaseType->isObjCIdType() ||
3263 BaseType->isObjCQualifiedIdType())) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003264 const ObjCObjectPointerType *QIdTy = BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003265 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003266
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003267 // Check protocols on qualified interfaces.
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003268 Selector Sel = PP.getSelectorTable().getNullarySelector(Member);
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003269 if (Decl *PMDecl = FindGetterNameDecl(QIdTy, Member, Sel, Context)) {
3270 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = dyn_cast<ObjCPropertyDecl>(PMDecl)) {
3271 // Check the use of this declaration
3272 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(PD, MemberLoc))
3273 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003274
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003275 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCPropertyRefExpr(PD, PD->getType(),
3276 MemberLoc, BaseExpr));
3277 }
3278 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(PMDecl)) {
3279 // Check the use of this method.
3280 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(OMD, MemberLoc))
3281 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003282
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003283 return Owned(ObjCMessageExpr::Create(Context,
Douglas Gregor603d81b2010-07-13 08:18:22 +00003284 OMD->getSendResultType(),
Douglas Gregor9a129192010-04-21 00:45:42 +00003285 OpLoc, BaseExpr, Sel,
3286 OMD, NULL, 0, MemberLoc));
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003287 }
3288 }
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003289
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003290 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_property_not_found)
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003291 << MemberName << BaseType);
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003292 }
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003293
Chris Lattnerdc420f42008-07-21 04:59:05 +00003294 // Handle Objective-C property access, which is "Obj.property" where Obj is a
3295 // pointer to a (potentially qualified) interface type.
Chris Lattner2b1ca5f2010-04-11 07:45:24 +00003296 if (!IsArrow)
3297 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
3298 BaseType->getAsObjCInterfacePointerType())
Chris Lattner90c58fa2010-04-11 07:51:10 +00003299 return HandleExprPropertyRefExpr(OPT, BaseExpr, MemberName, MemberLoc);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003300
Steve Naroffe87026a2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003301 // Handle the following exceptional case (*Obj).isa.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003302 if (!IsArrow &&
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003303 BaseType->isObjCObjectType() &&
3304 BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectType>()->isObjCId() &&
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003305 MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo()->isStr("isa"))
Steve Naroffe87026a2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003306 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIsaExpr(BaseExpr, false, MemberLoc,
Fariborz Jahaniana5fee262009-12-09 19:05:56 +00003307 Context.getObjCClassType()));
Steve Naroffe87026a2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003308
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003309 // Handle 'field access' to vectors, such as 'V.xx'.
Chris Lattner6c7ce102009-02-16 21:11:58 +00003310 if (BaseType->isExtVectorType()) {
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003311 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003312 QualType ret = CheckExtVectorComponent(BaseType, OpLoc, Member, MemberLoc);
3313 if (ret.isNull())
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003314 return ExprError();
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003315 return Owned(new (Context) ExtVectorElementExpr(ret, BaseExpr, *Member,
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00003316 MemberLoc));
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003317 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003318
Douglas Gregor0b08ba42009-03-27 06:00:30 +00003319 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_struct_union)
3320 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
3321
Douglas Gregor0b08ba42009-03-27 06:00:30 +00003322 return ExprError();
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00003323}
3324
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003325/// The main callback when the parser finds something like
3326/// expression . [nested-name-specifier] identifier
3327/// expression -> [nested-name-specifier] identifier
3328/// where 'identifier' encompasses a fairly broad spectrum of
3329/// possibilities, including destructor and operator references.
3330///
3331/// \param OpKind either tok::arrow or tok::period
3332/// \param HasTrailingLParen whether the next token is '(', which
3333/// is used to diagnose mis-uses of special members that can
3334/// only be called
3335/// \param ObjCImpDecl the current ObjC @implementation decl;
3336/// this is an ugly hack around the fact that ObjC @implementations
3337/// aren't properly put in the context chain
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003338ExprResult Sema::ActOnMemberAccessExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Base,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003339 SourceLocation OpLoc,
3340 tok::TokenKind OpKind,
Jeffrey Yasskinc76498d2010-04-08 16:38:48 +00003341 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003342 UnqualifiedId &Id,
John McCall48871652010-08-21 09:40:31 +00003343 Decl *ObjCImpDecl,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003344 bool HasTrailingLParen) {
3345 if (SS.isSet() && SS.isInvalid())
3346 return ExprError();
3347
3348 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer;
3349
3350 // Decompose the name into its component parts.
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003351 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003352 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs;
3353 DecomposeUnqualifiedId(*this, Id, TemplateArgsBuffer,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003354 NameInfo, TemplateArgs);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003355
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003356 DeclarationName Name = NameInfo.getName();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003357 bool IsArrow = (OpKind == tok::arrow);
3358
3359 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope
3360 = (!SS.isSet() ? 0 : FindFirstQualifierInScope(S,
3361 static_cast<NestedNameSpecifier*>(SS.getScopeRep())));
3362
3363 // This is a postfix expression, so get rid of ParenListExprs.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003364 ExprResult Result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, Base);
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003365 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
3366 Base = Result.take();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003367
Douglas Gregor41f90302010-04-12 20:54:26 +00003368 if (Base->getType()->isDependentType() || Name.isDependentName() ||
3369 isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS)) {
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003370 Result = ActOnDependentMemberExpr(Base, Base->getType(),
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003371 IsArrow, OpLoc,
3372 SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003373 NameInfo, TemplateArgs);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003374 } else {
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003375 LookupResult R(*this, NameInfo, LookupMemberName);
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003376 Result = LookupMemberExpr(R, Base, IsArrow, OpLoc,
3377 SS, ObjCImpDecl, TemplateArgs != 0);
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003378
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003379 if (Result.isInvalid()) {
3380 Owned(Base);
3381 return ExprError();
3382 }
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003383
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003384 if (Result.get()) {
3385 // The only way a reference to a destructor can be used is to
3386 // immediately call it, which falls into this case. If the
3387 // next token is not a '(', produce a diagnostic and build the
3388 // call now.
3389 if (!HasTrailingLParen &&
3390 Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedId::IK_DestructorName)
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003391 return DiagnoseDtorReference(NameInfo.getLoc(), Result.get());
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003392
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003393 return move(Result);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003394 }
3395
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003396 Result = BuildMemberReferenceExpr(Base, Base->getType(),
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00003397 OpLoc, IsArrow, SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
3398 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003399 }
3400
3401 return move(Result);
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003402}
3403
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003404ExprResult Sema::BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(SourceLocation CallLoc,
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003405 FunctionDecl *FD,
3406 ParmVarDecl *Param) {
3407 if (Param->hasUnparsedDefaultArg()) {
3408 Diag (CallLoc,
3409 diag::err_use_of_default_argument_to_function_declared_later) <<
3410 FD << cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->getDeclName();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003411 Diag(UnparsedDefaultArgLocs[Param],
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003412 diag::note_default_argument_declared_here);
3413 } else {
3414 if (Param->hasUninstantiatedDefaultArg()) {
3415 Expr *UninstExpr = Param->getUninstantiatedDefaultArg();
3416
3417 // Instantiate the expression.
Douglas Gregor8c702532010-02-05 07:33:43 +00003418 MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList ArgList
3419 = getTemplateInstantiationArgs(FD, 0, /*RelativeToPrimary=*/true);
Anders Carlsson657bad42009-09-05 05:14:19 +00003420
Douglas Gregor9961ce92010-07-08 18:37:38 +00003421 std::pair<const TemplateArgument *, unsigned> Innermost
3422 = ArgList.getInnermost();
3423 InstantiatingTemplate Inst(*this, CallLoc, Param, Innermost.first,
3424 Innermost.second);
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003425
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003426 ExprResult Result = SubstExpr(UninstExpr, ArgList);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003427 if (Result.isInvalid())
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003428 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003429
Douglas Gregor25ab25f2009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003430 // Check the expression as an initializer for the parameter.
3431 InitializedEntity Entity
3432 = InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Param);
3433 InitializationKind Kind
3434 = InitializationKind::CreateCopy(Param->getLocation(),
3435 /*FIXME:EqualLoc*/UninstExpr->getSourceRange().getBegin());
3436 Expr *ResultE = Result.takeAs<Expr>();
3437
3438 InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, &ResultE, 1);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003439 Result = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind,
John McCall37ad5512010-08-23 06:44:23 +00003440 MultiExprArg(*this, &ResultE, 1));
Douglas Gregor25ab25f2009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003441 if (Result.isInvalid())
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003442 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003443
Douglas Gregor25ab25f2009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003444 // Build the default argument expression.
Douglas Gregor033f6752009-12-23 23:03:06 +00003445 return Owned(CXXDefaultArgExpr::Create(Context, CallLoc, Param,
Douglas Gregor25ab25f2009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003446 Result.takeAs<Expr>()));
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003447 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003448
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003449 // If the default expression creates temporaries, we need to
3450 // push them to the current stack of expression temporaries so they'll
3451 // be properly destroyed.
Douglas Gregor25ab25f2009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003452 // FIXME: We should really be rebuilding the default argument with new
3453 // bound temporaries; see the comment in PR5810.
Anders Carlsson714d0962009-12-15 19:16:31 +00003454 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Param->getNumDefaultArgTemporaries(); i != e; ++i)
3455 ExprTemporaries.push_back(Param->getDefaultArgTemporary(i));
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003456 }
3457
3458 // We already type-checked the argument, so we know it works.
Douglas Gregor033f6752009-12-23 23:03:06 +00003459 return Owned(CXXDefaultArgExpr::Create(Context, CallLoc, Param));
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003460}
3461
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003462/// ConvertArgumentsForCall - Converts the arguments specified in
3463/// Args/NumArgs to the parameter types of the function FDecl with
3464/// function prototype Proto. Call is the call expression itself, and
3465/// Fn is the function expression. For a C++ member function, this
3466/// routine does not attempt to convert the object argument. Returns
3467/// true if the call is ill-formed.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003468bool
3469Sema::ConvertArgumentsForCall(CallExpr *Call, Expr *Fn,
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003470 FunctionDecl *FDecl,
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003471 const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003472 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3473 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003474 // C99 6.5.2.2p7 - the arguments are implicitly converted, as if by
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003475 // assignment, to the types of the corresponding parameter, ...
3476 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
Douglas Gregorb6b99612009-01-23 21:30:56 +00003477 bool Invalid = false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003478
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003479 // If too few arguments are available (and we don't have default
3480 // arguments for the remaining parameters), don't make the call.
3481 if (NumArgs < NumArgsInProto) {
3482 if (!FDecl || NumArgs < FDecl->getMinRequiredArguments())
3483 return Diag(RParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_too_few_args)
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003484 << Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()
Eric Christopherabf1e182010-04-16 04:48:22 +00003485 << NumArgsInProto << NumArgs << Fn->getSourceRange();
Ted Kremenek5a201952009-02-07 01:47:29 +00003486 Call->setNumArgs(Context, NumArgsInProto);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003487 }
3488
3489 // If too many are passed and not variadic, error on the extras and drop
3490 // them.
3491 if (NumArgs > NumArgsInProto) {
3492 if (!Proto->isVariadic()) {
3493 Diag(Args[NumArgsInProto]->getLocStart(),
3494 diag::err_typecheck_call_too_many_args)
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003495 << Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()
Eric Christopher2a5aaff2010-04-16 04:56:46 +00003496 << NumArgsInProto << NumArgs << Fn->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003497 << SourceRange(Args[NumArgsInProto]->getLocStart(),
3498 Args[NumArgs-1]->getLocEnd());
3499 // This deletes the extra arguments.
Ted Kremenek5a201952009-02-07 01:47:29 +00003500 Call->setNumArgs(Context, NumArgsInProto);
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003501 return true;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003502 }
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003503 }
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003504 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> AllArgs;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003505 VariadicCallType CallType =
Fariborz Jahanian6f2d25e2009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003506 Proto->isVariadic() ? VariadicFunction : VariadicDoesNotApply;
3507 if (Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType())
3508 CallType = VariadicBlock; // Block
3509 else if (isa<MemberExpr>(Fn))
3510 CallType = VariadicMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003511 Invalid = GatherArgumentsForCall(Call->getSourceRange().getBegin(), FDecl,
Fariborz Jahanian4fa66ce2009-11-24 21:37:28 +00003512 Proto, 0, Args, NumArgs, AllArgs, CallType);
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003513 if (Invalid)
3514 return true;
3515 unsigned TotalNumArgs = AllArgs.size();
3516 for (unsigned i = 0; i < TotalNumArgs; ++i)
3517 Call->setArg(i, AllArgs[i]);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003518
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003519 return false;
3520}
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003521
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003522bool Sema::GatherArgumentsForCall(SourceLocation CallLoc,
3523 FunctionDecl *FDecl,
3524 const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
3525 unsigned FirstProtoArg,
3526 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3527 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> &AllArgs,
Fariborz Jahanian6f2d25e2009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003528 VariadicCallType CallType) {
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003529 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
3530 unsigned NumArgsToCheck = NumArgs;
3531 bool Invalid = false;
3532 if (NumArgs != NumArgsInProto)
3533 // Use default arguments for missing arguments
3534 NumArgsToCheck = NumArgsInProto;
3535 unsigned ArgIx = 0;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003536 // Continue to check argument types (even if we have too few/many args).
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003537 for (unsigned i = FirstProtoArg; i != NumArgsToCheck; i++) {
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003538 QualType ProtoArgType = Proto->getArgType(i);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003539
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003540 Expr *Arg;
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003541 if (ArgIx < NumArgs) {
3542 Arg = Args[ArgIx++];
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003543
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003544 if (RequireCompleteType(Arg->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
3545 ProtoArgType,
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003546 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_argument)
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003547 << Arg->getSourceRange()))
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003548 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003549
Douglas Gregorbbeb5c32009-12-22 16:09:06 +00003550 // Pass the argument
3551 ParmVarDecl *Param = 0;
3552 if (FDecl && i < FDecl->getNumParams())
3553 Param = FDecl->getParamDecl(i);
Douglas Gregor96596c92009-12-22 07:24:36 +00003554
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003555
Douglas Gregorbbeb5c32009-12-22 16:09:06 +00003556 InitializedEntity Entity =
3557 Param? InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Param)
3558 : InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(ProtoArgType);
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003559 ExprResult ArgE = PerformCopyInitialization(Entity,
Douglas Gregorbbeb5c32009-12-22 16:09:06 +00003560 SourceLocation(),
3561 Owned(Arg));
3562 if (ArgE.isInvalid())
3563 return true;
3564
3565 Arg = ArgE.takeAs<Expr>();
Anders Carlsson84613c42009-06-12 16:51:40 +00003566 } else {
Anders Carlssonc80a1272009-08-25 02:29:20 +00003567 ParmVarDecl *Param = FDecl->getParamDecl(i);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003568
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003569 ExprResult ArgExpr =
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003570 BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(CallLoc, FDecl, Param);
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003571 if (ArgExpr.isInvalid())
3572 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003573
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003574 Arg = ArgExpr.takeAs<Expr>();
Anders Carlsson84613c42009-06-12 16:51:40 +00003575 }
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003576 AllArgs.push_back(Arg);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003577 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003578
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003579 // If this is a variadic call, handle args passed through "...".
Fariborz Jahanian6f2d25e2009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003580 if (CallType != VariadicDoesNotApply) {
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003581 // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p7).
Chris Lattnerbb53efb2010-05-16 04:01:30 +00003582 for (unsigned i = ArgIx; i != NumArgs; ++i) {
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003583 Expr *Arg = Args[i];
Chris Lattnerbb53efb2010-05-16 04:01:30 +00003584 Invalid |= DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Arg, CallType, FDecl);
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003585 AllArgs.push_back(Arg);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003586 }
3587 }
Douglas Gregorb6b99612009-01-23 21:30:56 +00003588 return Invalid;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003589}
3590
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003591/// ActOnCallExpr - Handle a call to Fn with the specified array of arguments.
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00003592/// This provides the location of the left/right parens and a list of comma
3593/// locations.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003594ExprResult
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003595Sema::ActOnCallExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Fn, SourceLocation LParenLoc,
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003596 MultiExprArg args,
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003597 SourceLocation *CommaLocs, SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003598 unsigned NumArgs = args.size();
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00003599
3600 // Since this might be a postfix expression, get rid of ParenListExprs.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003601 ExprResult Result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, Fn);
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003602 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
3603 Fn = Result.take();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003604
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003605 Expr **Args = args.release();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003606
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003607 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003608 // If this is a pseudo-destructor expression, build the call immediately.
3609 if (isa<CXXPseudoDestructorExpr>(Fn)) {
3610 if (NumArgs > 0) {
3611 // Pseudo-destructor calls should not have any arguments.
3612 Diag(Fn->getLocStart(), diag::err_pseudo_dtor_call_with_args)
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003613 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003614 SourceRange(Args[0]->getLocStart(),
3615 Args[NumArgs-1]->getLocEnd()));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003616
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003617 NumArgs = 0;
3618 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003619
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003620 return Owned(new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn, 0, 0, Context.VoidTy,
3621 RParenLoc));
3622 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003623
Douglas Gregorb8a9a412009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003624 // Determine whether this is a dependent call inside a C++ template,
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003625 // in which case we won't do any semantic analysis now.
Mike Stump87c57ac2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00003626 // FIXME: Will need to cache the results of name lookup (including ADL) in
3627 // Fn.
Douglas Gregorb8a9a412009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003628 bool Dependent = false;
3629 if (Fn->isTypeDependent())
3630 Dependent = true;
3631 else if (Expr::hasAnyTypeDependentArguments(Args, NumArgs))
3632 Dependent = true;
3633
3634 if (Dependent)
Ted Kremenekd7b4f402009-02-09 20:51:47 +00003635 return Owned(new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregorb8a9a412009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003636 Context.DependentTy, RParenLoc));
3637
3638 // Determine whether this is a call to an object (C++ [over.call.object]).
3639 if (Fn->getType()->isRecordType())
3640 return Owned(BuildCallToObjectOfClassType(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
3641 CommaLocs, RParenLoc));
3642
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003643 Expr *NakedFn = Fn->IgnoreParens();
3644
3645 // Determine whether this is a call to an unresolved member function.
3646 if (UnresolvedMemberExpr *MemE = dyn_cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(NakedFn)) {
3647 // If lookup was unresolved but not dependent (i.e. didn't find
3648 // an unresolved using declaration), it has to be an overloaded
3649 // function set, which means it must contain either multiple
3650 // declarations (all methods or method templates) or a single
3651 // method template.
3652 assert((MemE->getNumDecls() > 1) ||
Douglas Gregor516d6722010-04-25 21:15:30 +00003653 isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(
3654 (*MemE->decls_begin())->getUnderlyingDecl()));
Douglas Gregor8f184a32009-12-01 03:34:29 +00003655 (void)MemE;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003656
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003657 return BuildCallToMemberFunction(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
3658 CommaLocs, RParenLoc);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003659 }
3660
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00003661 // Determine whether this is a call to a member function.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003662 if (MemberExpr *MemExpr = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(NakedFn)) {
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00003663 NamedDecl *MemDecl = MemExpr->getMemberDecl();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003664 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(MemDecl))
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003665 return BuildCallToMemberFunction(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
3666 CommaLocs, RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00003667 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003668
Anders Carlsson61914b52009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003669 // Determine whether this is a call to a pointer-to-member function.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003670 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(NakedFn)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003671 if (BO->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemD ||
3672 BO->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemI) {
Douglas Gregorc8be9522010-05-04 18:18:31 +00003673 if (const FunctionProtoType *FPT
3674 = BO->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
Douglas Gregor603d81b2010-07-13 08:18:22 +00003675 QualType ResultTy = FPT->getCallResultType(Context);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003676
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003677 CXXMemberCallExpr *TheCall
3678 = new (Context) CXXMemberCallExpr(Context, BO, Args,
3679 NumArgs, ResultTy,
3680 RParenLoc);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003681
3682 if (CheckCallReturnType(FPT->getResultType(),
3683 BO->getRHS()->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003684 TheCall, 0))
Fariborz Jahanian42f66632009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003685 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson63dce022009-10-15 00:41:48 +00003686
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003687 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(TheCall, BO, 0, FPT, Args, NumArgs,
Fariborz Jahanian42f66632009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003688 RParenLoc))
3689 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson61914b52009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003690
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003691 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Fariborz Jahanian42f66632009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003692 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003693 return ExprError(Diag(Fn->getLocStart(),
Fariborz Jahanian42f66632009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003694 diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
3695 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
Anders Carlsson61914b52009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003696 }
3697 }
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003698 }
3699
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00003700 // If we're directly calling a function, get the appropriate declaration.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003701 // Also, in C++, keep track of whether we should perform argument-dependent
Douglas Gregor89026b52009-06-30 23:57:56 +00003702 // lookup and whether there were any explicitly-specified template arguments.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003703
Eli Friedmane14b1992009-12-26 03:35:45 +00003704 Expr *NakedFn = Fn->IgnoreParens();
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003705 if (isa<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(NakedFn)) {
3706 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(NakedFn);
Douglas Gregor2fb18b72010-04-14 20:27:54 +00003707 return BuildOverloadedCallExpr(S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003708 CommaLocs, RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003709 }
Chris Lattneraa9c7ae2008-04-08 04:40:51 +00003710
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003711 NamedDecl *NDecl = 0;
3712 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(NakedFn))
3713 NDecl = cast<DeclRefExpr>(NakedFn)->getDecl();
3714
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003715 return BuildResolvedCallExpr(Fn, NDecl, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs, RParenLoc);
3716}
3717
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003718/// BuildResolvedCallExpr - Build a call to a resolved expression,
3719/// i.e. an expression not of \p OverloadTy. The expression should
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003720/// unary-convert to an expression of function-pointer or
3721/// block-pointer type.
3722///
3723/// \param NDecl the declaration being called, if available
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003724ExprResult
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003725Sema::BuildResolvedCallExpr(Expr *Fn, NamedDecl *NDecl,
3726 SourceLocation LParenLoc,
3727 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3728 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
3729 FunctionDecl *FDecl = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(NDecl);
3730
Chris Lattneraa9c7ae2008-04-08 04:40:51 +00003731 // Promote the function operand.
3732 UsualUnaryConversions(Fn);
3733
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003734 // Make the call expr early, before semantic checks. This guarantees cleanup
3735 // of arguments and function on error.
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003736 CallExpr *TheCall = new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn,
3737 Args, NumArgs,
3738 Context.BoolTy,
3739 RParenLoc);
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003740
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003741 const FunctionType *FuncT;
3742 if (!Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()) {
3743 // C99 6.5.2.2p1 - "The expression that denotes the called function shall
3744 // have type pointer to function".
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003745 const PointerType *PT = Fn->getType()->getAs<PointerType>();
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003746 if (PT == 0)
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003747 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
3748 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003749 FuncT = PT->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>();
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003750 } else { // This is a block call.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003751 FuncT = Fn->getType()->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType()->
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003752 getAs<FunctionType>();
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003753 }
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003754 if (FuncT == 0)
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003755 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
3756 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
3757
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003758 // Check for a valid return type
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003759 if (CheckCallReturnType(FuncT->getResultType(),
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003760 Fn->getSourceRange().getBegin(), TheCall,
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00003761 FDecl))
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003762 return ExprError();
3763
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003764 // We know the result type of the call, set it.
Douglas Gregor603d81b2010-07-13 08:18:22 +00003765 TheCall->setType(FuncT->getCallResultType(Context));
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003766
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003767 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FuncT)) {
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003768 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(TheCall, Fn, FDecl, Proto, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003769 RParenLoc))
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003770 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003771 } else {
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003772 assert(isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(FuncT) && "Unknown FunctionType!");
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003773
Douglas Gregord8e97de2009-04-02 15:37:10 +00003774 if (FDecl) {
3775 // Check if we have too few/too many template arguments, based
3776 // on our knowledge of the function definition.
3777 const FunctionDecl *Def = 0;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis36ea3222010-07-07 11:31:19 +00003778 if (FDecl->hasBody(Def) && NumArgs != Def->param_size()) {
Eli Friedmanfcbf7d22009-06-01 09:24:59 +00003779 const FunctionProtoType *Proto =
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003780 Def->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
Eli Friedmanfcbf7d22009-06-01 09:24:59 +00003781 if (!Proto || !(Proto->isVariadic() && NumArgs >= Def->param_size())) {
3782 Diag(RParenLoc, diag::warn_call_wrong_number_of_arguments)
3783 << (NumArgs > Def->param_size()) << FDecl << Fn->getSourceRange();
3784 }
3785 }
Douglas Gregord8e97de2009-04-02 15:37:10 +00003786 }
3787
Steve Naroff0b661582007-08-28 23:30:39 +00003788 // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p6).
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003789 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumArgs; i++) {
3790 Expr *Arg = Args[i];
3791 DefaultArgumentPromotion(Arg);
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003792 if (RequireCompleteType(Arg->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
3793 Arg->getType(),
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003794 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_argument)
3795 << Arg->getSourceRange()))
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003796 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003797 TheCall->setArg(i, Arg);
Steve Naroff0b661582007-08-28 23:30:39 +00003798 }
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00003799 }
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003800
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003801 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXMethodDecl>(FDecl))
3802 if (!Method->isStatic())
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003803 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_member_call_without_object)
3804 << Fn->getSourceRange());
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003805
Fariborz Jahanian0aa5c452009-05-15 20:33:25 +00003806 // Check for sentinels
3807 if (NDecl)
3808 DiagnoseSentinelCalls(NDecl, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003809
Chris Lattnerb87b1b32007-08-10 20:18:51 +00003810 // Do special checking on direct calls to functions.
Anders Carlssonbc4c1072009-08-16 01:56:34 +00003811 if (FDecl) {
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003812 if (CheckFunctionCall(FDecl, TheCall))
Anders Carlssonbc4c1072009-08-16 01:56:34 +00003813 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003814
Douglas Gregor15fc9562009-09-12 00:22:50 +00003815 if (unsigned BuiltinID = FDecl->getBuiltinID())
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003816 return CheckBuiltinFunctionCall(BuiltinID, TheCall);
Anders Carlssonbc4c1072009-08-16 01:56:34 +00003817 } else if (NDecl) {
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003818 if (CheckBlockCall(NDecl, TheCall))
Anders Carlssonbc4c1072009-08-16 01:56:34 +00003819 return ExprError();
3820 }
Chris Lattnerb87b1b32007-08-10 20:18:51 +00003821
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003822 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00003823}
3824
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003825ExprResult
John McCallba7bf592010-08-24 05:47:05 +00003826Sema::ActOnCompoundLiteral(SourceLocation LParenLoc, ParsedType Ty,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003827 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *InitExpr) {
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003828 assert((Ty != 0) && "ActOnCompoundLiteral(): missing type");
Steve Naroff57eb2c52007-07-19 21:32:11 +00003829 // FIXME: put back this assert when initializers are worked out.
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003830 //assert((InitExpr != 0) && "ActOnCompoundLiteral(): missing expression");
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003831
3832 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
3833 QualType literalType = GetTypeFromParser(Ty, &TInfo);
3834 if (!TInfo)
3835 TInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(literalType);
3836
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003837 return BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, InitExpr);
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003838}
3839
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003840ExprResult
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003841Sema::BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003842 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *literalExpr) {
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003843 QualType literalType = TInfo->getType();
Anders Carlsson2c1ec6d2007-12-05 07:24:19 +00003844
Eli Friedman37a186d2008-05-20 05:22:08 +00003845 if (literalType->isArrayType()) {
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00003846 if (literalType->isVariableArrayType())
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003847 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_variable_object_no_init)
3848 << SourceRange(LParenLoc, literalExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd()));
Douglas Gregor1c37d9e2009-05-21 23:48:18 +00003849 } else if (!literalType->isDependentType() &&
3850 RequireCompleteType(LParenLoc, literalType,
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003851 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_decl_incomplete_type)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003852 << SourceRange(LParenLoc,
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003853 literalExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd())))
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003854 return ExprError();
Eli Friedman37a186d2008-05-20 05:22:08 +00003855
Douglas Gregor85dabae2009-12-16 01:38:02 +00003856 InitializedEntity Entity
Douglas Gregor1b303932009-12-22 15:35:07 +00003857 = InitializedEntity::InitializeTemporary(literalType);
Douglas Gregor85dabae2009-12-16 01:38:02 +00003858 InitializationKind Kind
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003859 = InitializationKind::CreateCast(SourceRange(LParenLoc, RParenLoc),
Douglas Gregor85dabae2009-12-16 01:38:02 +00003860 /*IsCStyleCast=*/true);
Eli Friedmana553d4a2009-12-22 02:35:53 +00003861 InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, &literalExpr, 1);
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003862 ExprResult Result = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind,
John McCall37ad5512010-08-23 06:44:23 +00003863 MultiExprArg(*this, &literalExpr, 1),
Eli Friedmana553d4a2009-12-22 02:35:53 +00003864 &literalType);
3865 if (Result.isInvalid())
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003866 return ExprError();
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003867 literalExpr = Result.get();
Steve Naroffd32419d2008-01-14 18:19:28 +00003868
Chris Lattner79413952008-12-04 23:50:19 +00003869 bool isFileScope = getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl() == 0;
Steve Naroffd32419d2008-01-14 18:19:28 +00003870 if (isFileScope) { // 6.5.2.5p3
Steve Naroff98f72032008-01-10 22:15:12 +00003871 if (CheckForConstantInitializer(literalExpr, literalType))
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003872 return ExprError();
Steve Naroff98f72032008-01-10 22:15:12 +00003873 }
Eli Friedmana553d4a2009-12-22 02:35:53 +00003874
John McCall5d7aa7f2010-01-19 22:33:45 +00003875 return Owned(new (Context) CompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, literalType,
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00003876 literalExpr, isFileScope));
Steve Narofffbd09832007-07-19 01:06:55 +00003877}
3878
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003879ExprResult
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003880Sema::ActOnInitList(SourceLocation LBraceLoc, MultiExprArg initlist,
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003881 SourceLocation RBraceLoc) {
3882 unsigned NumInit = initlist.size();
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003883 Expr **InitList = initlist.release();
Anders Carlsson4692db02007-08-31 04:56:16 +00003884
Steve Naroff30d242c2007-09-15 18:49:24 +00003885 // Semantic analysis for initializers is done by ActOnDeclarator() and
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003886 // CheckInitializer() - it requires knowledge of the object being intialized.
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003887
Ted Kremenekac034612010-04-13 23:39:13 +00003888 InitListExpr *E = new (Context) InitListExpr(Context, LBraceLoc, InitList,
3889 NumInit, RBraceLoc);
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00003890 E->setType(Context.VoidTy); // FIXME: just a place holder for now.
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003891 return Owned(E);
Steve Narofffbd09832007-07-19 01:06:55 +00003892}
3893
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003894static CastKind getScalarCastKind(ASTContext &Context,
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003895 QualType SrcTy, QualType DestTy) {
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00003896 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(SrcTy, DestTy))
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003897 return CK_NoOp;
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003898
3899 if (SrcTy->hasPointerRepresentation()) {
3900 if (DestTy->hasPointerRepresentation())
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003901 return DestTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() ?
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003902 CK_AnyPointerToObjCPointerCast :
3903 CK_BitCast;
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003904 if (DestTy->isIntegerType())
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003905 return CK_PointerToIntegral;
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003906 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003907
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003908 if (SrcTy->isIntegerType()) {
3909 if (DestTy->isIntegerType())
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003910 return CK_IntegralCast;
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003911 if (DestTy->hasPointerRepresentation())
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003912 return CK_IntegralToPointer;
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003913 if (DestTy->isRealFloatingType())
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003914 return CK_IntegralToFloating;
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003915 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003916
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003917 if (SrcTy->isRealFloatingType()) {
3918 if (DestTy->isRealFloatingType())
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003919 return CK_FloatingCast;
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003920 if (DestTy->isIntegerType())
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003921 return CK_FloatingToIntegral;
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003922 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003923
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003924 // FIXME: Assert here.
3925 // assert(false && "Unhandled cast combination!");
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003926 return CK_Unknown;
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003927}
3928
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003929/// CheckCastTypes - Check type constraints for casting between types.
Sebastian Redl955a0672009-07-29 13:50:23 +00003930bool Sema::CheckCastTypes(SourceRange TyR, QualType castType, Expr *&castExpr,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003931 CastKind& Kind,
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00003932 CXXCastPath &BasePath,
Fariborz Jahanian1cec0c42009-08-26 18:55:36 +00003933 bool FunctionalStyle) {
Sebastian Redl9f831db2009-07-25 15:41:38 +00003934 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Anders Carlssona70cff62010-04-24 19:06:50 +00003935 return CXXCheckCStyleCast(TyR, castType, castExpr, Kind, BasePath,
3936 FunctionalStyle);
Sebastian Redl9f831db2009-07-25 15:41:38 +00003937
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00003938 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(castExpr);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003939
3940 // C99 6.5.4p2: the cast type needs to be void or scalar and the expression
3941 // type needs to be scalar.
3942 if (castType->isVoidType()) {
3943 // Cast to void allows any expr type.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003944 Kind = CK_ToVoid;
Anders Carlssonef918ac2009-10-16 02:35:04 +00003945 return false;
3946 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003947
Eli Friedmane98194d2010-07-17 20:43:49 +00003948 if (RequireCompleteType(TyR.getBegin(), castType,
3949 diag::err_typecheck_cast_to_incomplete))
3950 return true;
3951
Anders Carlssonef918ac2009-10-16 02:35:04 +00003952 if (!castType->isScalarType() && !castType->isVectorType()) {
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00003953 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(castType, castExpr->getType()) &&
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003954 (castType->isStructureType() || castType->isUnionType())) {
3955 // GCC struct/union extension: allow cast to self.
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00003956 // FIXME: Check that the cast destination type is complete.
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003957 Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::ext_typecheck_cast_nonscalar)
3958 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003959 Kind = CK_NoOp;
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003960 return false;
3961 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003962
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003963 if (castType->isUnionType()) {
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003964 // GCC cast to union extension
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003965 RecordDecl *RD = castType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl();
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003966 RecordDecl::field_iterator Field, FieldEnd;
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscfbfe782009-06-30 02:36:12 +00003967 for (Field = RD->field_begin(), FieldEnd = RD->field_end();
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003968 Field != FieldEnd; ++Field) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003969 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(Field->getType(),
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00003970 castExpr->getType())) {
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003971 Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::ext_typecheck_cast_to_union)
3972 << castExpr->getSourceRange();
3973 break;
3974 }
3975 }
3976 if (Field == FieldEnd)
3977 return Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::err_typecheck_cast_to_union_no_type)
3978 << castExpr->getType() << castExpr->getSourceRange();
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003979 Kind = CK_ToUnion;
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003980 return false;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003981 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003982
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003983 // Reject any other conversions to non-scalar types.
3984 return Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
3985 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
3986 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003987
3988 if (!castExpr->getType()->isScalarType() &&
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003989 !castExpr->getType()->isVectorType()) {
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00003990 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
3991 diag::err_typecheck_expect_scalar_operand)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00003992 << castExpr->getType() << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003993 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003994
3995 if (castType->isExtVectorType())
Anders Carlsson43d70f82009-10-16 05:23:41 +00003996 return CheckExtVectorCast(TyR, castType, castExpr, Kind);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003997
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003998 if (castType->isVectorType())
3999 return CheckVectorCast(TyR, castType, castExpr->getType(), Kind);
4000 if (castExpr->getType()->isVectorType())
4001 return CheckVectorCast(TyR, castExpr->getType(), castType, Kind);
4002
Anders Carlsson43d70f82009-10-16 05:23:41 +00004003 if (isa<ObjCSelectorExpr>(castExpr))
4004 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_cast_selector_expr);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004005
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004006 if (!castType->isArithmeticType()) {
Eli Friedmanf4e3ad62009-05-01 02:23:58 +00004007 QualType castExprType = castExpr->getType();
Douglas Gregor6972a622010-06-16 00:35:25 +00004008 if (!castExprType->isIntegralType(Context) &&
Douglas Gregorb90df602010-06-16 00:17:44 +00004009 castExprType->isArithmeticType())
Eli Friedmanf4e3ad62009-05-01 02:23:58 +00004010 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
4011 diag::err_cast_pointer_from_non_pointer_int)
4012 << castExprType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
4013 } else if (!castExpr->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
Douglas Gregor6972a622010-06-16 00:35:25 +00004014 if (!castType->isIntegralType(Context) && castType->isArithmeticType())
Eli Friedmanf4e3ad62009-05-01 02:23:58 +00004015 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
4016 diag::err_cast_pointer_to_non_pointer_int)
4017 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00004018 }
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00004019
4020 Kind = getScalarCastKind(Context, castExpr->getType(), castType);
John McCall2b5c1b22010-08-12 21:44:57 +00004021
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004022 if (Kind == CK_Unknown || Kind == CK_BitCast)
John McCall2b5c1b22010-08-12 21:44:57 +00004023 CheckCastAlign(castExpr, castType, TyR);
4024
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00004025 return false;
4026}
4027
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004028bool Sema::CheckVectorCast(SourceRange R, QualType VectorTy, QualType Ty,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004029 CastKind &Kind) {
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004030 assert(VectorTy->isVectorType() && "Not a vector type!");
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004031
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004032 if (Ty->isVectorType() || Ty->isIntegerType()) {
Chris Lattner37e05872008-03-05 18:54:05 +00004033 if (Context.getTypeSize(VectorTy) != Context.getTypeSize(Ty))
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004034 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004035 Ty->isVectorType() ?
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004036 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vectors :
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00004037 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_integer)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00004038 << VectorTy << Ty << R;
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004039 } else
4040 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00004041 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_scalar)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00004042 << VectorTy << Ty << R;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004043
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004044 Kind = CK_BitCast;
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004045 return false;
4046}
4047
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004048bool Sema::CheckExtVectorCast(SourceRange R, QualType DestTy, Expr *&CastExpr,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004049 CastKind &Kind) {
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004050 assert(DestTy->isExtVectorType() && "Not an extended vector type!");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004051
Anders Carlsson43d70f82009-10-16 05:23:41 +00004052 QualType SrcTy = CastExpr->getType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004053
Nate Begemanc8961a42009-06-27 22:05:55 +00004054 // If SrcTy is a VectorType, the total size must match to explicitly cast to
4055 // an ExtVectorType.
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004056 if (SrcTy->isVectorType()) {
4057 if (Context.getTypeSize(DestTy) != Context.getTypeSize(SrcTy))
4058 return Diag(R.getBegin(),diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_ext_vectors)
4059 << DestTy << SrcTy << R;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004060 Kind = CK_BitCast;
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004061 return false;
4062 }
4063
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004064 // All non-pointer scalars can be cast to ExtVector type. The appropriate
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004065 // conversion will take place first from scalar to elt type, and then
4066 // splat from elt type to vector.
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004067 if (SrcTy->isPointerType())
4068 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
4069 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_scalar)
4070 << DestTy << SrcTy << R;
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004071
4072 QualType DestElemTy = DestTy->getAs<ExtVectorType>()->getElementType();
4073 ImpCastExprToType(CastExpr, DestElemTy,
4074 getScalarCastKind(Context, SrcTy, DestElemTy));
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004075
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004076 Kind = CK_VectorSplat;
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004077 return false;
4078}
4079
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004080ExprResult
John McCallba7bf592010-08-24 05:47:05 +00004081Sema::ActOnCastExpr(Scope *S, SourceLocation LParenLoc, ParsedType Ty,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004082 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *castExpr) {
4083 assert((Ty != 0) && (castExpr != 0) &&
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004084 "ActOnCastExpr(): missing type or expr");
Steve Naroff1a2cf6b2007-07-16 23:25:18 +00004085
John McCall97513962010-01-15 18:39:57 +00004086 TypeSourceInfo *castTInfo;
4087 QualType castType = GetTypeFromParser(Ty, &castTInfo);
4088 if (!castTInfo)
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004089 castTInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(castType);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004090
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004091 // If the Expr being casted is a ParenListExpr, handle it specially.
4092 if (isa<ParenListExpr>(castExpr))
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004093 return ActOnCastOfParenListExpr(S, LParenLoc, RParenLoc, castExpr,
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004094 castTInfo);
John McCallebe54742010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004095
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004096 return BuildCStyleCastExpr(LParenLoc, castTInfo, RParenLoc, castExpr);
John McCallebe54742010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004097}
4098
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004099ExprResult
John McCallebe54742010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004100Sema::BuildCStyleCastExpr(SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeSourceInfo *Ty,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004101 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *castExpr) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004102 CastKind Kind = CK_Unknown;
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00004103 CXXCastPath BasePath;
John McCallebe54742010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004104 if (CheckCastTypes(SourceRange(LParenLoc, RParenLoc), Ty->getType(), castExpr,
Anders Carlssona70cff62010-04-24 19:06:50 +00004105 Kind, BasePath))
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004106 return ExprError();
Anders Carlssone9766d52009-09-09 21:33:21 +00004107
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00004108 return Owned(CStyleCastExpr::Create(Context,
Douglas Gregora8a089b2010-07-13 18:40:04 +00004109 Ty->getType().getNonLValueExprType(Context),
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00004110 Kind, castExpr, &BasePath, Ty,
4111 LParenLoc, RParenLoc));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00004112}
4113
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004114/// This is not an AltiVec-style cast, so turn the ParenListExpr into a sequence
4115/// of comma binary operators.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004116ExprResult
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004117Sema::MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(Scope *S, Expr *expr) {
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004118 ParenListExpr *E = dyn_cast<ParenListExpr>(expr);
4119 if (!E)
4120 return Owned(expr);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004121
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004122 ExprResult Result(E->getExpr(0));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004123
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004124 for (unsigned i = 1, e = E->getNumExprs(); i != e && !Result.isInvalid(); ++i)
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004125 Result = ActOnBinOp(S, E->getExprLoc(), tok::comma, Result.get(),
4126 E->getExpr(i));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004127
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004128 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
4129
4130 return ActOnParenExpr(E->getLParenLoc(), E->getRParenLoc(), Result.get());
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004131}
4132
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004133ExprResult
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004134Sema::ActOnCastOfParenListExpr(Scope *S, SourceLocation LParenLoc,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004135 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *Op,
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004136 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo) {
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004137 ParenListExpr *PE = cast<ParenListExpr>(Op);
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004138 QualType Ty = TInfo->getType();
John Thompson781ad172010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004139 bool isAltiVecLiteral = false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004140
John Thompson781ad172010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004141 // Check for an altivec literal,
4142 // i.e. all the elements are integer constants.
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004143 if (getLangOptions().AltiVec && Ty->isVectorType()) {
4144 if (PE->getNumExprs() == 0) {
4145 Diag(PE->getExprLoc(), diag::err_altivec_empty_initializer);
4146 return ExprError();
4147 }
John Thompson781ad172010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004148 if (PE->getNumExprs() == 1) {
4149 if (!PE->getExpr(0)->getType()->isVectorType())
4150 isAltiVecLiteral = true;
4151 }
4152 else
4153 isAltiVecLiteral = true;
4154 }
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004155
John Thompson781ad172010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004156 // If this is an altivec initializer, '(' type ')' '(' init, ..., init ')'
4157 // then handle it as such.
4158 if (isAltiVecLiteral) {
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004159 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> initExprs;
4160 for (unsigned i = 0, e = PE->getNumExprs(); i != e; ++i)
4161 initExprs.push_back(PE->getExpr(i));
4162
4163 // FIXME: This means that pretty-printing the final AST will produce curly
4164 // braces instead of the original commas.
Ted Kremenekac034612010-04-13 23:39:13 +00004165 InitListExpr *E = new (Context) InitListExpr(Context, LParenLoc,
4166 &initExprs[0],
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004167 initExprs.size(), RParenLoc);
4168 E->setType(Ty);
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004169 return BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, E);
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004170 } else {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004171 // This is not an AltiVec-style cast, so turn the ParenListExpr into a
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004172 // sequence of BinOp comma operators.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004173 ExprResult Result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, Op);
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004174 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
4175 return BuildCStyleCastExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, Result.take());
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004176 }
4177}
4178
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004179ExprResult Sema::ActOnParenOrParenListExpr(SourceLocation L,
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004180 SourceLocation R,
Fariborz Jahanian906d8712009-11-25 01:26:41 +00004181 MultiExprArg Val,
John McCallba7bf592010-08-24 05:47:05 +00004182 ParsedType TypeOfCast) {
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004183 unsigned nexprs = Val.size();
4184 Expr **exprs = reinterpret_cast<Expr**>(Val.release());
Fariborz Jahanian906d8712009-11-25 01:26:41 +00004185 assert((exprs != 0) && "ActOnParenOrParenListExpr() missing expr list");
4186 Expr *expr;
4187 if (nexprs == 1 && TypeOfCast && !TypeIsVectorType(TypeOfCast))
4188 expr = new (Context) ParenExpr(L, R, exprs[0]);
4189 else
4190 expr = new (Context) ParenListExpr(Context, L, exprs, nexprs, R);
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004191 return Owned(expr);
4192}
4193
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00004194/// Note that lhs is not null here, even if this is the gnu "x ?: y" extension.
4195/// In that case, lhs = cond.
Chris Lattner2c486602009-02-18 04:38:20 +00004196/// C99 6.5.15
4197QualType Sema::CheckConditionalOperands(Expr *&Cond, Expr *&LHS, Expr *&RHS,
4198 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
Sebastian Redl1a99f442009-04-16 17:51:27 +00004199 // C++ is sufficiently different to merit its own checker.
4200 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
4201 return CXXCheckConditionalOperands(Cond, LHS, RHS, QuestionLoc);
4202
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004203 UsualUnaryConversions(Cond);
4204 UsualUnaryConversions(LHS);
4205 UsualUnaryConversions(RHS);
4206 QualType CondTy = Cond->getType();
4207 QualType LHSTy = LHS->getType();
4208 QualType RHSTy = RHS->getType();
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00004209
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004210 // first, check the condition.
Sebastian Redl1a99f442009-04-16 17:51:27 +00004211 if (!CondTy->isScalarType()) { // C99 6.5.15p2
4212 Diag(Cond->getLocStart(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
4213 << CondTy;
4214 return QualType();
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004215 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004216
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004217 // Now check the two expressions.
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004218 if (LHSTy->isVectorType() || RHSTy->isVectorType())
4219 return CheckVectorOperands(QuestionLoc, LHS, RHS);
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00004220
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004221 // If both operands have arithmetic type, do the usual arithmetic conversions
4222 // to find a common type: C99 6.5.15p3,5.
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004223 if (LHSTy->isArithmeticType() && RHSTy->isArithmeticType()) {
4224 UsualArithmeticConversions(LHS, RHS);
4225 return LHS->getType();
Steve Naroffdbd9e892007-07-17 00:58:39 +00004226 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004227
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004228 // If both operands are the same structure or union type, the result is that
4229 // type.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004230 if (const RecordType *LHSRT = LHSTy->getAs<RecordType>()) { // C99 6.5.15p3
4231 if (const RecordType *RHSRT = RHSTy->getAs<RecordType>())
Chris Lattner2ab40a62007-11-26 01:40:58 +00004232 if (LHSRT->getDecl() == RHSRT->getDecl())
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004233 // "If both the operands have structure or union type, the result has
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004234 // that type." This implies that CV qualifiers are dropped.
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004235 return LHSTy.getUnqualifiedType();
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00004236 // FIXME: Type of conditional expression must be complete in C mode.
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004237 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004238
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004239 // C99 6.5.15p5: "If both operands have void type, the result has void type."
Steve Naroffbf1516c2008-05-12 21:44:38 +00004240 // The following || allows only one side to be void (a GCC-ism).
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004241 if (LHSTy->isVoidType() || RHSTy->isVoidType()) {
4242 if (!LHSTy->isVoidType())
4243 Diag(RHS->getLocStart(), diag::ext_typecheck_cond_one_void)
4244 << RHS->getSourceRange();
4245 if (!RHSTy->isVoidType())
4246 Diag(LHS->getLocStart(), diag::ext_typecheck_cond_one_void)
4247 << LHS->getSourceRange();
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004248 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, Context.VoidTy, CK_ToVoid);
4249 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, Context.VoidTy, CK_ToVoid);
Eli Friedman3e1852f2008-06-04 19:47:51 +00004250 return Context.VoidTy;
Steve Naroffbf1516c2008-05-12 21:44:38 +00004251 }
Steve Naroff039ad3c2008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004252 // C99 6.5.15p6 - "if one operand is a null pointer constant, the result has
4253 // the type of the other operand."
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00004254 if ((LHSTy->isAnyPointerType() || LHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) &&
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004255 RHS->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004256 // promote the null to a pointer.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004257 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_Unknown);
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004258 return LHSTy;
Steve Naroff039ad3c2008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004259 }
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00004260 if ((RHSTy->isAnyPointerType() || RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) &&
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004261 LHS->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004262 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CK_Unknown);
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004263 return RHSTy;
Steve Naroff039ad3c2008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004264 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004265
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004266 // All objective-c pointer type analysis is done here.
4267 QualType compositeType = FindCompositeObjCPointerType(LHS, RHS,
4268 QuestionLoc);
4269 if (!compositeType.isNull())
4270 return compositeType;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004271
4272
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004273 // Handle block pointer types.
4274 if (LHSTy->isBlockPointerType() || RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) {
4275 if (!LHSTy->isBlockPointerType() || !RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) {
4276 if (LHSTy->isVoidPointerType() || RHSTy->isVoidPointerType()) {
4277 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004278 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
4279 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004280 return destType;
4281 }
4282 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004283 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004284 return QualType();
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004285 }
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004286 // We have 2 block pointer types.
4287 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4288 // Two identical block pointer types are always compatible.
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004289 return LHSTy;
4290 }
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004291 // The block pointer types aren't identical, continue checking.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004292 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4293 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004294
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004295 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee.getUnqualifiedType(),
4296 rhptee.getUnqualifiedType())) {
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004297 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_incompatible_pointers)
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004298 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004299 // In this situation, we assume void* type. No especially good
4300 // reason, but this is what gcc does, and we do have to pick
4301 // to get a consistent AST.
4302 QualType incompatTy = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004303 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
4304 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004305 return incompatTy;
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004306 }
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004307 // The block pointer types are compatible.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004308 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
4309 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroffea4c7802009-04-08 17:05:15 +00004310 return LHSTy;
4311 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004312
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004313 // Check constraints for C object pointers types (C99 6.5.15p3,6).
4314 if (LHSTy->isPointerType() && RHSTy->isPointerType()) {
4315 // get the "pointed to" types
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004316 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4317 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004318
4319 // ignore qualifiers on void (C99 6.5.15p3, clause 6)
4320 if (lhptee->isVoidType() && rhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType()) {
4321 // Figure out necessary qualifiers (C99 6.5.15p6)
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004322 QualType destPointee
4323 = Context.getQualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee.getQualifiers());
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004324 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004325 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004326 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CK_NoOp);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004327 // Promote to void*.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004328 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004329 return destType;
4330 }
4331 if (rhptee->isVoidType() && lhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType()) {
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004332 QualType destPointee
4333 = Context.getQualifiedType(rhptee, lhptee.getQualifiers());
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004334 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004335 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004336 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CK_NoOp);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004337 // Promote to void*.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004338 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004339 return destType;
4340 }
4341
4342 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4343 // Two identical pointer types are always compatible.
4344 return LHSTy;
4345 }
4346 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee.getUnqualifiedType(),
4347 rhptee.getUnqualifiedType())) {
4348 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_incompatible_pointers)
4349 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
4350 // In this situation, we assume void* type. No especially good
4351 // reason, but this is what gcc does, and we do have to pick
4352 // to get a consistent AST.
4353 QualType incompatTy = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004354 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
4355 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004356 return incompatTy;
4357 }
4358 // The pointer types are compatible.
4359 // C99 6.5.15p6: If both operands are pointers to compatible types *or* to
4360 // differently qualified versions of compatible types, the result type is
4361 // a pointer to an appropriately qualified version of the *composite*
4362 // type.
4363 // FIXME: Need to calculate the composite type.
4364 // FIXME: Need to add qualifiers
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004365 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
4366 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004367 return LHSTy;
4368 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004369
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004370 // GCC compatibility: soften pointer/integer mismatch.
4371 if (RHSTy->isPointerType() && LHSTy->isIntegerType()) {
4372 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_pointer_integer_mismatch)
4373 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004374 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CK_IntegralToPointer);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004375 return RHSTy;
4376 }
4377 if (LHSTy->isPointerType() && RHSTy->isIntegerType()) {
4378 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_pointer_integer_mismatch)
4379 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004380 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_IntegralToPointer);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004381 return LHSTy;
4382 }
Daniel Dunbar484603b2008-09-11 23:12:46 +00004383
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004384 // Otherwise, the operands are not compatible.
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004385 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
4386 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004387 return QualType();
Steve Narofff8a28c52007-05-15 20:29:32 +00004388}
4389
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004390/// FindCompositeObjCPointerType - Helper method to find composite type of
4391/// two objective-c pointer types of the two input expressions.
4392QualType Sema::FindCompositeObjCPointerType(Expr *&LHS, Expr *&RHS,
4393 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
4394 QualType LHSTy = LHS->getType();
4395 QualType RHSTy = RHS->getType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004396
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004397 // Handle things like Class and struct objc_class*. Here we case the result
4398 // to the pseudo-builtin, because that will be implicitly cast back to the
4399 // redefinition type if an attempt is made to access its fields.
4400 if (LHSTy->isObjCClassType() &&
4401 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004402 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004403 return LHSTy;
4404 }
4405 if (RHSTy->isObjCClassType() &&
4406 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004407 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004408 return RHSTy;
4409 }
4410 // And the same for struct objc_object* / id
4411 if (LHSTy->isObjCIdType() &&
4412 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004413 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004414 return LHSTy;
4415 }
4416 if (RHSTy->isObjCIdType() &&
4417 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004418 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004419 return RHSTy;
4420 }
4421 // And the same for struct objc_selector* / SEL
4422 if (Context.isObjCSelType(LHSTy) &&
4423 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004424 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004425 return LHSTy;
4426 }
4427 if (Context.isObjCSelType(RHSTy) &&
4428 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004429 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004430 return RHSTy;
4431 }
4432 // Check constraints for Objective-C object pointers types.
4433 if (LHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004434
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004435 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4436 // Two identical object pointer types are always compatible.
4437 return LHSTy;
4438 }
4439 const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT = LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4440 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT = RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4441 QualType compositeType = LHSTy;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004442
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004443 // If both operands are interfaces and either operand can be
4444 // assigned to the other, use that type as the composite
4445 // type. This allows
4446 // xxx ? (A*) a : (B*) b
4447 // where B is a subclass of A.
4448 //
4449 // Additionally, as for assignment, if either type is 'id'
4450 // allow silent coercion. Finally, if the types are
4451 // incompatible then make sure to use 'id' as the composite
4452 // type so the result is acceptable for sending messages to.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004453
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004454 // FIXME: Consider unifying with 'areComparableObjCPointerTypes'.
4455 // It could return the composite type.
4456 if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHSOPT, RHSOPT)) {
4457 compositeType = RHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() ? RHSTy : LHSTy;
4458 } else if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(RHSOPT, LHSOPT)) {
4459 compositeType = LHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() ? LHSTy : RHSTy;
4460 } else if ((LHSTy->isObjCQualifiedIdType() ||
4461 RHSTy->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) &&
4462 Context.ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(LHSTy, RHSTy, true)) {
4463 // Need to handle "id<xx>" explicitly.
4464 // GCC allows qualified id and any Objective-C type to devolve to
4465 // id. Currently localizing to here until clear this should be
4466 // part of ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible.
4467 compositeType = Context.getObjCIdType();
4468 } else if (LHSTy->isObjCIdType() || RHSTy->isObjCIdType()) {
4469 compositeType = Context.getObjCIdType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004470 } else if (!(compositeType =
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004471 Context.areCommonBaseCompatible(LHSOPT, RHSOPT)).isNull())
4472 ;
4473 else {
4474 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::ext_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
4475 << LHSTy << RHSTy
4476 << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
4477 QualType incompatTy = Context.getObjCIdType();
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004478 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
4479 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004480 return incompatTy;
4481 }
4482 // The object pointer types are compatible.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004483 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, compositeType, CK_BitCast);
4484 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, compositeType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004485 return compositeType;
4486 }
4487 // Check Objective-C object pointer types and 'void *'
4488 if (LHSTy->isVoidPointerType() && RHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
4489 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4490 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4491 QualType destPointee
4492 = Context.getQualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee.getQualifiers());
4493 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
4494 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004495 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CK_NoOp);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004496 // Promote to void*.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004497 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004498 return destType;
4499 }
4500 if (LHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSTy->isVoidPointerType()) {
4501 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4502 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4503 QualType destPointee
4504 = Context.getQualifiedType(rhptee, lhptee.getQualifiers());
4505 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
4506 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004507 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CK_NoOp);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004508 // Promote to void*.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004509 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004510 return destType;
4511 }
4512 return QualType();
4513}
4514
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00004515/// ActOnConditionalOp - Parse a ?: operation. Note that 'LHS' may be null
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00004516/// in the case of a the GNU conditional expr extension.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004517ExprResult Sema::ActOnConditionalOp(SourceLocation QuestionLoc,
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004518 SourceLocation ColonLoc,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004519 Expr *CondExpr, Expr *LHSExpr,
4520 Expr *RHSExpr) {
Chris Lattner2ab40a62007-11-26 01:40:58 +00004521 // If this is the gnu "x ?: y" extension, analyze the types as though the LHS
4522 // was the condition.
4523 bool isLHSNull = LHSExpr == 0;
4524 if (isLHSNull)
4525 LHSExpr = CondExpr;
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004526
4527 QualType result = CheckConditionalOperands(CondExpr, LHSExpr,
Chris Lattnerdaaa9f22007-07-16 21:39:03 +00004528 RHSExpr, QuestionLoc);
Steve Narofff8a28c52007-05-15 20:29:32 +00004529 if (result.isNull())
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004530 return ExprError();
4531
Douglas Gregor7e112b02009-08-26 14:37:04 +00004532 return Owned(new (Context) ConditionalOperator(CondExpr, QuestionLoc,
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00004533 isLHSNull ? 0 : LHSExpr,
Douglas Gregor7e112b02009-08-26 14:37:04 +00004534 ColonLoc, RHSExpr, result));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00004535}
4536
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004537// CheckPointerTypesForAssignment - This is a very tricky routine (despite
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004538// being closely modeled after the C99 spec:-). The odd characteristic of this
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004539// routine is it effectively iqnores the qualifiers on the top level pointee.
4540// This circumvents the usual type rules specified in 6.2.7p1 & 6.7.5.[1-3].
4541// FIXME: add a couple examples in this comment.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004542Sema::AssignConvertType
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004543Sema::CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004544 QualType lhptee, rhptee;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004545
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00004546 if ((lhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4547 (rhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) ||
4548 (rhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4549 (lhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType))) {
4550 return Compatible;
4551 }
4552
Steve Naroff1f4d7272007-05-11 04:00:31 +00004553 // get the "pointed to" type (ignoring qualifiers at the top level)
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004554 lhptee = lhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4555 rhptee = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004556
Steve Naroff1f4d7272007-05-11 04:00:31 +00004557 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +00004558 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4559 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
Steve Naroff1f4d7272007-05-11 04:00:31 +00004560
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004561 AssignConvertType ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004562
4563 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: This following citation is common to constraints
4564 // 3 & 4 (below). ...and the type *pointed to* by the left has all the
4565 // qualifiers of the type *pointed to* by the right;
Fariborz Jahanianece85822009-02-17 18:27:45 +00004566 // FIXME: Handle ExtQualType
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00004567 if (!lhptee.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(rhptee))
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004568 ConvTy = CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004569
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004570 // C99 6.5.16.1p1 (constraint 4): If one operand is a pointer to an object or
4571 // incomplete type and the other is a pointer to a qualified or unqualified
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004572 // version of void...
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004573 if (lhptee->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattnerb3a176d2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004574 if (rhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType())
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004575 return ConvTy;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004576
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004577 // As an extension, we allow cast to/from void* to function pointer.
Chris Lattnerb3a176d2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004578 assert(rhptee->isFunctionType());
4579 return FunctionVoidPointer;
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004580 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004581
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004582 if (rhptee->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattnerb3a176d2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004583 if (lhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType())
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004584 return ConvTy;
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004585
4586 // As an extension, we allow cast to/from void* to function pointer.
Chris Lattnerb3a176d2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004587 assert(lhptee->isFunctionType());
4588 return FunctionVoidPointer;
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004589 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004590 // C99 6.5.16.1p1 (constraint 3): both operands are pointers to qualified or
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004591 // unqualified versions of compatible types, ...
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004592 lhptee = lhptee.getUnqualifiedType();
4593 rhptee = rhptee.getUnqualifiedType();
4594 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee, rhptee)) {
4595 // Check if the pointee types are compatible ignoring the sign.
4596 // We explicitly check for char so that we catch "char" vs
4597 // "unsigned char" on systems where "char" is unsigned.
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004598 if (lhptee->isCharType())
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004599 lhptee = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00004600 else if (lhptee->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation())
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004601 lhptee = Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(lhptee);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004602
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004603 if (rhptee->isCharType())
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004604 rhptee = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00004605 else if (rhptee->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation())
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004606 rhptee = Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(rhptee);
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004607
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004608 if (lhptee == rhptee) {
4609 // Types are compatible ignoring the sign. Qualifier incompatibility
4610 // takes priority over sign incompatibility because the sign
4611 // warning can be disabled.
4612 if (ConvTy != Compatible)
4613 return ConvTy;
4614 return IncompatiblePointerSign;
4615 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004616
Fariborz Jahaniand7aa9d82009-11-07 20:20:40 +00004617 // If we are a multi-level pointer, it's possible that our issue is simply
4618 // one of qualification - e.g. char ** -> const char ** is not allowed. If
4619 // the eventual target type is the same and the pointers have the same
4620 // level of indirection, this must be the issue.
4621 if (lhptee->isPointerType() && rhptee->isPointerType()) {
4622 do {
4623 lhptee = lhptee->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4624 rhptee = rhptee->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004625
Fariborz Jahaniand7aa9d82009-11-07 20:20:40 +00004626 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4627 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
4628 } while (lhptee->isPointerType() && rhptee->isPointerType());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004629
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004630 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee))
Alexis Hunt6f3de502009-11-08 07:46:34 +00004631 return IncompatibleNestedPointerQualifiers;
Fariborz Jahaniand7aa9d82009-11-07 20:20:40 +00004632 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004633
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004634 // General pointer incompatibility takes priority over qualifiers.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004635 return IncompatiblePointer;
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004636 }
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004637 return ConvTy;
Steve Naroff1f4d7272007-05-11 04:00:31 +00004638}
4639
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004640/// CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment - This routine determines whether two
4641/// block pointer types are compatible or whether a block and normal pointer
4642/// are compatible. It is more restrict than comparing two function pointer
4643// types.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004644Sema::AssignConvertType
4645Sema::CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType,
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004646 QualType rhsType) {
4647 QualType lhptee, rhptee;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004648
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004649 // get the "pointed to" type (ignoring qualifiers at the top level)
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004650 lhptee = lhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4651 rhptee = rhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004652
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004653 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
4654 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4655 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004656
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004657 AssignConvertType ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004658
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004659 // For blocks we enforce that qualifiers are identical.
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004660 if (lhptee.getLocalCVRQualifiers() != rhptee.getLocalCVRQualifiers())
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004661 ConvTy = CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004662
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00004663 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
4664 if (!Context.typesAreBlockPointerCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
4665 return IncompatibleBlockPointer;
4666 }
4667 else if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee, rhptee))
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004668 return IncompatibleBlockPointer;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004669 return ConvTy;
4670}
4671
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004672/// CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment - Compares two objective-c pointer types
4673/// for assignment compatibility.
4674Sema::AssignConvertType
4675Sema::CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
Fariborz Jahaniand5bb8cb2010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004676 if (lhsType->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
4677 // Class is not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Fariborz Jahanian9b37b1d2010-03-24 21:00:27 +00004678 if (lhsType->isObjCClassType() && !rhsType->isObjCBuiltinType() &&
4679 !rhsType->isObjCQualifiedClassType())
Fariborz Jahaniand5bb8cb2010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004680 return IncompatiblePointer;
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004681 return Compatible;
Fariborz Jahaniand5bb8cb2010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004682 }
4683 if (rhsType->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
4684 // Class is not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Fariborz Jahanian9b37b1d2010-03-24 21:00:27 +00004685 if (rhsType->isObjCClassType() && !lhsType->isObjCBuiltinType() &&
4686 !lhsType->isObjCQualifiedClassType())
Fariborz Jahaniand5bb8cb2010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004687 return IncompatiblePointer;
4688 return Compatible;
4689 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004690 QualType lhptee =
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004691 lhsType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004692 QualType rhptee =
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004693 rhsType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4694 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
4695 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4696 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
4697 if (!lhptee.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(rhptee))
4698 return CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004699
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004700 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
4701 return Compatible;
4702 if (lhsType->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || rhsType->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
4703 return IncompatibleObjCQualifiedId;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004704 return IncompatiblePointer;
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004705}
4706
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004707/// CheckAssignmentConstraints (C99 6.5.16) - This routine currently
4708/// has code to accommodate several GCC extensions when type checking
Steve Naroff17f76e02007-05-03 21:03:48 +00004709/// pointers. Here are some objectionable examples that GCC considers warnings:
4710///
4711/// int a, *pint;
4712/// short *pshort;
4713/// struct foo *pfoo;
4714///
4715/// pint = pshort; // warning: assignment from incompatible pointer type
4716/// a = pint; // warning: assignment makes integer from pointer without a cast
4717/// pint = a; // warning: assignment makes pointer from integer without a cast
4718/// pint = pfoo; // warning: assignment from incompatible pointer type
4719///
4720/// As a result, the code for dealing with pointers is more complex than the
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004721/// C99 spec dictates.
Steve Naroff17f76e02007-05-03 21:03:48 +00004722///
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004723Sema::AssignConvertType
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004724Sema::CheckAssignmentConstraints(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004725 // Get canonical types. We're not formatting these types, just comparing
4726 // them.
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +00004727 lhsType = Context.getCanonicalType(lhsType).getUnqualifiedType();
4728 rhsType = Context.getCanonicalType(rhsType).getUnqualifiedType();
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004729
4730 if (lhsType == rhsType)
Chris Lattnerf5c973d2008-01-07 17:51:46 +00004731 return Compatible; // Common case: fast path an exact match.
Steve Naroff44fd8ff2007-07-24 21:46:40 +00004732
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00004733 if ((lhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4734 (rhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) ||
4735 (rhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4736 (lhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType))) {
4737 return Compatible;
4738 }
4739
Douglas Gregor6b754842008-10-28 00:22:11 +00004740 // If the left-hand side is a reference type, then we are in a
4741 // (rare!) case where we've allowed the use of references in C,
4742 // e.g., as a parameter type in a built-in function. In this case,
4743 // just make sure that the type referenced is compatible with the
4744 // right-hand side type. The caller is responsible for adjusting
4745 // lhsType so that the resulting expression does not have reference
4746 // type.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004747 if (const ReferenceType *lhsTypeRef = lhsType->getAs<ReferenceType>()) {
Douglas Gregor6b754842008-10-28 00:22:11 +00004748 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsTypeRef->getPointeeType(), rhsType))
Anders Carlsson24ebce62007-10-12 23:56:29 +00004749 return Compatible;
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004750 return Incompatible;
Fariborz Jahaniana1e34202007-12-19 17:45:58 +00004751 }
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004752 // Allow scalar to ExtVector assignments, and assignments of an ExtVector type
4753 // to the same ExtVector type.
4754 if (lhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
4755 if (rhsType->isExtVectorType())
4756 return lhsType == rhsType ? Compatible : Incompatible;
Douglas Gregora3208f92010-06-22 23:41:02 +00004757 if (rhsType->isArithmeticType())
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004758 return Compatible;
4759 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004760
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004761 if (lhsType->isVectorType() || rhsType->isVectorType()) {
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00004762 if (lhsType->isVectorType() && rhsType->isVectorType()) {
4763 // If we are allowing lax vector conversions, and LHS and RHS are both
4764 // vectors, the total size only needs to be the same. This is a bitcast;
4765 // no bits are changed but the result type is different.
4766 if (getLangOptions().LaxVectorConversions &&
4767 (Context.getTypeSize(lhsType) == Context.getTypeSize(rhsType)))
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00004768 return IncompatibleVectors;
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00004769
4770 // Allow assignments of an AltiVec vector type to an equivalent GCC
4771 // vector type and vice versa
4772 if (Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(lhsType, rhsType))
4773 return Compatible;
Chris Lattner881a2122008-01-04 23:32:24 +00004774 }
4775 return Incompatible;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004776 }
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004777
Douglas Gregorbea453a2010-05-23 21:53:47 +00004778 if (lhsType->isArithmeticType() && rhsType->isArithmeticType() &&
4779 !(getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && lhsType->isEnumeralType()))
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004780 return Compatible;
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004781
Chris Lattnerec646832008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004782 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType)) {
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004783 if (rhsType->isIntegerType())
Chris Lattner940cfeb2008-01-04 18:22:42 +00004784 return IntToPointer;
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004785
Chris Lattnerec646832008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004786 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType))
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004787 return CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004788
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004789 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004790 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(rhsType)) {
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004791 if (lhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
4792 return Compatible;
4793 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004794 }
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004795 if (rhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) {
4796 if (lhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregore7dd1452008-11-27 00:44:28 +00004797 return Compatible;
Steve Naroff32d072c2008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004798
4799 // Treat block pointers as objects.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004800 if (getLangOptions().ObjC1 && lhsType->isObjCIdType())
Steve Naroff32d072c2008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004801 return Compatible;
4802 }
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004803 return Incompatible;
4804 }
4805
4806 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType)) {
4807 if (rhsType->isIntegerType())
Eli Friedman8163b7a2009-02-25 04:20:42 +00004808 return IntToBlockPointer;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004809
Steve Naroff32d072c2008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004810 // Treat block pointers as objects.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004811 if (getLangOptions().ObjC1 && rhsType->isObjCIdType())
Steve Naroff32d072c2008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004812 return Compatible;
4813
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004814 if (rhsType->isBlockPointerType())
4815 return CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004816
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004817 if (const PointerType *RHSPT = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004818 if (RHSPT->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregore7dd1452008-11-27 00:44:28 +00004819 return Compatible;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004820 }
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004821 return Incompatible;
4822 }
4823
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004824 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(lhsType)) {
4825 if (rhsType->isIntegerType())
4826 return IntToPointer;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004827
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004828 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004829 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType)) {
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004830 if (rhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
4831 return Compatible;
4832 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004833 }
4834 if (rhsType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004835 return CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004836 }
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004837 if (const PointerType *RHSPT = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004838 if (RHSPT->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
4839 return Compatible;
4840 }
4841 // Treat block pointers as objects.
4842 if (rhsType->isBlockPointerType())
4843 return Compatible;
4844 return Incompatible;
4845 }
Chris Lattnerec646832008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004846 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType)) {
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004847 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is _Bool and the right is a pointer.
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004848 if (lhsType == Context.BoolTy)
4849 return Compatible;
4850
4851 if (lhsType->isIntegerType())
Chris Lattner940cfeb2008-01-04 18:22:42 +00004852 return PointerToInt;
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004853
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004854 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType))
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004855 return CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004856
4857 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType) &&
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004858 rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregore7dd1452008-11-27 00:44:28 +00004859 return Compatible;
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004860 return Incompatible;
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004861 }
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004862 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(rhsType)) {
4863 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is _Bool and the right is a pointer.
4864 if (lhsType == Context.BoolTy)
4865 return Compatible;
4866
4867 if (lhsType->isIntegerType())
4868 return PointerToInt;
4869
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004870 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004871 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType)) {
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004872 if (lhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
4873 return Compatible;
4874 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004875 }
4876 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType) &&
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004877 rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004878 return Compatible;
4879 return Incompatible;
4880 }
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004881
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004882 if (isa<TagType>(lhsType) && isa<TagType>(rhsType)) {
Chris Lattnerec646832008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004883 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004884 return Compatible;
Bill Wendling216423b2007-05-30 06:30:29 +00004885 }
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004886 return Incompatible;
Steve Naroff9eb24652007-05-02 21:58:15 +00004887}
4888
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004889/// \brief Constructs a transparent union from an expression that is
4890/// used to initialize the transparent union.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004891static void ConstructTransparentUnion(ASTContext &C, Expr *&E,
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004892 QualType UnionType, FieldDecl *Field) {
4893 // Build an initializer list that designates the appropriate member
4894 // of the transparent union.
Ted Kremenekac034612010-04-13 23:39:13 +00004895 InitListExpr *Initializer = new (C) InitListExpr(C, SourceLocation(),
Ted Kremenek013041e2010-02-19 01:50:18 +00004896 &E, 1,
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004897 SourceLocation());
4898 Initializer->setType(UnionType);
4899 Initializer->setInitializedFieldInUnion(Field);
4900
4901 // Build a compound literal constructing a value of the transparent
4902 // union type from this initializer list.
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004903 TypeSourceInfo *unionTInfo = C.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(UnionType);
John McCall5d7aa7f2010-01-19 22:33:45 +00004904 E = new (C) CompoundLiteralExpr(SourceLocation(), unionTInfo, UnionType,
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004905 Initializer, false);
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004906}
4907
4908Sema::AssignConvertType
4909Sema::CheckTransparentUnionArgumentConstraints(QualType ArgType, Expr *&rExpr) {
4910 QualType FromType = rExpr->getType();
4911
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004912 // If the ArgType is a Union type, we want to handle a potential
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004913 // transparent_union GCC extension.
4914 const RecordType *UT = ArgType->getAsUnionType();
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb4b64ca2009-06-30 02:34:44 +00004915 if (!UT || !UT->getDecl()->hasAttr<TransparentUnionAttr>())
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004916 return Incompatible;
4917
4918 // The field to initialize within the transparent union.
4919 RecordDecl *UD = UT->getDecl();
4920 FieldDecl *InitField = 0;
4921 // It's compatible if the expression matches any of the fields.
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscfbfe782009-06-30 02:36:12 +00004922 for (RecordDecl::field_iterator it = UD->field_begin(),
4923 itend = UD->field_end();
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004924 it != itend; ++it) {
4925 if (it->getType()->isPointerType()) {
4926 // If the transparent union contains a pointer type, we allow:
4927 // 1) void pointer
4928 // 2) null pointer constant
4929 if (FromType->isPointerType())
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004930 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004931 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, it->getType(), CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004932 InitField = *it;
4933 break;
4934 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004935
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004936 if (rExpr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004937 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004938 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, it->getType(), CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004939 InitField = *it;
4940 break;
4941 }
4942 }
4943
4944 if (CheckAssignmentConstraints(it->getType(), rExpr->getType())
4945 == Compatible) {
4946 InitField = *it;
4947 break;
4948 }
4949 }
4950
4951 if (!InitField)
4952 return Incompatible;
4953
4954 ConstructTransparentUnion(Context, rExpr, ArgType, InitField);
4955 return Compatible;
4956}
4957
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004958Sema::AssignConvertType
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00004959Sema::CheckSingleAssignmentConstraints(QualType lhsType, Expr *&rExpr) {
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00004960 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
4961 if (!lhsType->isRecordType()) {
4962 // C++ 5.17p3: If the left operand is not of class type, the
4963 // expression is implicitly converted (C++ 4) to the
4964 // cv-unqualified type of the left operand.
Douglas Gregor47d3f272008-12-19 17:40:08 +00004965 if (PerformImplicitConversion(rExpr, lhsType.getUnqualifiedType(),
Douglas Gregor7c3bbdf2009-12-16 03:45:30 +00004966 AA_Assigning))
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00004967 return Incompatible;
Chris Lattner0d5640c2009-04-12 09:02:39 +00004968 return Compatible;
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00004969 }
4970
4971 // FIXME: Currently, we fall through and treat C++ classes like C
4972 // structures.
4973 }
4974
Steve Naroff0ee0b0a2007-11-27 17:58:44 +00004975 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is a pointer and the right is
4976 // a null pointer constant.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004977 if ((lhsType->isPointerType() ||
4978 lhsType->isObjCObjectPointerType() ||
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004979 lhsType->isBlockPointerType())
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004980 && rExpr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004981 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004982 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, lhsType, CK_Unknown);
Steve Naroff0ee0b0a2007-11-27 17:58:44 +00004983 return Compatible;
4984 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004985
Chris Lattnere6dcd502007-10-16 02:55:40 +00004986 // This check seems unnatural, however it is necessary to ensure the proper
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00004987 // conversion of functions/arrays. If the conversion were done for all
Douglas Gregora121b752009-11-03 16:56:39 +00004988 // DeclExpr's (created by ActOnIdExpression), it would mess up the unary
Nick Lewyckyef7c0ff2010-08-05 06:27:49 +00004989 // expressions that suppress this implicit conversion (&, sizeof).
Chris Lattnere6dcd502007-10-16 02:55:40 +00004990 //
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004991 // Suppress this for references: C++ 8.5.3p5.
Chris Lattnere6dcd502007-10-16 02:55:40 +00004992 if (!lhsType->isReferenceType())
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00004993 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(rExpr);
Steve Naroff0c1c7ed2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00004994
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004995 Sema::AssignConvertType result =
4996 CheckAssignmentConstraints(lhsType, rExpr->getType());
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004997
Steve Naroff0c1c7ed2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00004998 // C99 6.5.16.1p2: The value of the right operand is converted to the
4999 // type of the assignment expression.
Douglas Gregor6b754842008-10-28 00:22:11 +00005000 // CheckAssignmentConstraints allows the left-hand side to be a reference,
5001 // so that we can use references in built-in functions even in C.
5002 // The getNonReferenceType() call makes sure that the resulting expression
5003 // does not have reference type.
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005004 if (result != Incompatible && rExpr->getType() != lhsType)
Douglas Gregora8a089b2010-07-13 18:40:04 +00005005 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, lhsType.getNonLValueExprType(Context),
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005006 CK_Unknown);
Steve Naroff0c1c7ed2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00005007 return result;
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005008}
5009
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005010QualType Sema::InvalidOperands(SourceLocation Loc, Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex) {
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005011 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_invalid_operands)
Chris Lattner6a2ed6f2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00005012 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005013 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005014 return QualType();
Steve Naroff6f49f5d2007-05-29 14:23:36 +00005015}
5016
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005017QualType Sema::CheckVectorOperands(SourceLocation Loc, Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex) {
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005018 // For conversion purposes, we ignore any qualifiers.
Nate Begeman002e4bd2008-04-04 01:30:25 +00005019 // For example, "const float" and "float" are equivalent.
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +00005020 QualType lhsType =
5021 Context.getCanonicalType(lex->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
5022 QualType rhsType =
5023 Context.getCanonicalType(rex->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005024
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005025 // If the vector types are identical, return.
Nate Begeman002e4bd2008-04-04 01:30:25 +00005026 if (lhsType == rhsType)
Steve Naroff84ff4b42007-07-09 21:31:10 +00005027 return lhsType;
Nate Begeman330aaa72007-12-30 02:59:45 +00005028
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005029 // Handle the case of a vector & extvector type of the same size and element
5030 // type. It would be nice if we only had one vector type someday.
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00005031 if (getLangOptions().LaxVectorConversions) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005032 if (const VectorType *LV = lhsType->getAs<VectorType>()) {
Chandler Carruth9ed87ba2010-08-30 07:36:24 +00005033 if (const VectorType *RV = rhsType->getAs<VectorType>()) {
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005034 if (LV->getElementType() == RV->getElementType() &&
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00005035 LV->getNumElements() == RV->getNumElements()) {
Douglas Gregorcbfbca12010-05-19 03:21:00 +00005036 if (lhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005037 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorcbfbca12010-05-19 03:21:00 +00005038 return lhsType;
5039 }
5040
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005041 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rhsType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorcbfbca12010-05-19 03:21:00 +00005042 return rhsType;
Eric Christophera613f562010-08-26 00:42:16 +00005043 } else if (Context.getTypeSize(lhsType) ==Context.getTypeSize(rhsType)){
5044 // If we are allowing lax vector conversions, and LHS and RHS are both
5045 // vectors, the total size only needs to be the same. This is a
5046 // bitcast; no bits are changed but the result type is different.
5047 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CK_BitCast);
5048 return lhsType;
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00005049 }
Eric Christophera613f562010-08-26 00:42:16 +00005050 }
Chandler Carruth9ed87ba2010-08-30 07:36:24 +00005051 }
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00005052 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005053
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00005054 // Handle the case of equivalent AltiVec and GCC vector types
5055 if (lhsType->isVectorType() && rhsType->isVectorType() &&
5056 Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(lhsType, rhsType)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005057 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rhsType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00005058 return rhsType;
5059 }
5060
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005061 // Canonicalize the ExtVector to the LHS, remember if we swapped so we can
5062 // swap back (so that we don't reverse the inputs to a subtract, for instance.
5063 bool swapped = false;
5064 if (rhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
5065 swapped = true;
5066 std::swap(rex, lex);
5067 std::swap(rhsType, lhsType);
5068 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005069
Nate Begeman886448d2009-06-28 19:12:57 +00005070 // Handle the case of an ext vector and scalar.
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005071 if (const ExtVectorType *LV = lhsType->getAs<ExtVectorType>()) {
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005072 QualType EltTy = LV->getElementType();
Douglas Gregor6972a622010-06-16 00:35:25 +00005073 if (EltTy->isIntegralType(Context) && rhsType->isIntegralType(Context)) {
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005074 if (Context.getIntegerTypeOrder(EltTy, rhsType) >= 0) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005075 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CK_IntegralCast);
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005076 if (swapped) std::swap(rex, lex);
5077 return lhsType;
5078 }
5079 }
5080 if (EltTy->isRealFloatingType() && rhsType->isScalarType() &&
5081 rhsType->isRealFloatingType()) {
5082 if (Context.getFloatingTypeOrder(EltTy, rhsType) >= 0) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005083 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CK_FloatingCast);
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005084 if (swapped) std::swap(rex, lex);
5085 return lhsType;
5086 }
Nate Begeman330aaa72007-12-30 02:59:45 +00005087 }
5088 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005089
Nate Begeman886448d2009-06-28 19:12:57 +00005090 // Vectors of different size or scalar and non-ext-vector are errors.
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005091 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_vector_not_convertable)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005092 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005093 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff84ff4b42007-07-09 21:31:10 +00005094 return QualType();
Sebastian Redl112a97662009-02-07 00:15:38 +00005095}
5096
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005097QualType Sema::CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(
5098 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign, bool isDiv) {
Daniel Dunbar060d5e22009-01-05 22:42:10 +00005099 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005100 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005101
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005102 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005103
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005104 if (!lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() ||
5105 !rex->getType()->isArithmeticType())
5106 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005107
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005108 // Check for division by zero.
5109 if (isDiv &&
5110 rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull))
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005111 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_division_by_zero)
Chris Lattner70117952010-01-12 21:30:55 +00005112 << rex->getSourceRange());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005113
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005114 return compType;
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00005115}
5116
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005117QualType Sema::CheckRemainderOperands(
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005118 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign) {
Daniel Dunbar0d2bfec2009-01-05 22:55:36 +00005119 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00005120 if (lex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation() &&
5121 rex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation())
Daniel Dunbar0d2bfec2009-01-05 22:55:36 +00005122 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5123 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5124 }
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005125
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005126 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005127
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005128 if (!lex->getType()->isIntegerType() || !rex->getType()->isIntegerType())
5129 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005130
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005131 // Check for remainder by zero.
5132 if (rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull))
Chris Lattner70117952010-01-12 21:30:55 +00005133 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_remainder_by_zero)
5134 << rex->getSourceRange());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005135
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005136 return compType;
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005137}
5138
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005139QualType Sema::CheckAdditionOperands( // C99 6.5.6
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005140 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, QualType* CompLHSTy) {
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005141 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
5142 QualType compType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5143 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
5144 return compType;
5145 }
Steve Naroff7a5af782007-07-13 16:58:59 +00005146
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005147 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, CompLHSTy);
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005148
Steve Naroffe4718892007-04-27 18:30:00 +00005149 // handle the common case first (both operands are arithmetic).
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005150 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() &&
5151 rex->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
5152 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005153 return compType;
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005154 }
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005155
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005156 // Put any potential pointer into PExp
5157 Expr* PExp = lex, *IExp = rex;
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005158 if (IExp->getType()->isAnyPointerType())
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005159 std::swap(PExp, IExp);
5160
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005161 if (PExp->getType()->isAnyPointerType()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005162
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005163 if (IExp->getType()->isIntegerType()) {
Steve Naroffaacd4cc2009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005164 QualType PointeeTy = PExp->getType()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005165
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005166 // Check for arithmetic on pointers to incomplete types.
5167 if (PointeeTy->isVoidType()) {
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005168 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5169 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00005170 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregordd430f72009-01-19 19:26:10 +00005171 return QualType();
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005172 }
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005173
5174 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to void
5175 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5176 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005177 } else if (PointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005178 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5179 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
5180 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
5181 return QualType();
5182 }
5183
5184 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5185 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
5186 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffa63372d2009-07-13 21:32:29 +00005187 } else {
Steve Naroffaacd4cc2009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005188 // Check if we require a complete type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005189 if (((PExp->getType()->isPointerType() &&
Steve Naroffa63372d2009-07-13 21:32:29 +00005190 !PExp->getType()->isDependentType()) ||
Steve Naroffaacd4cc2009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005191 PExp->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType()) &&
5192 RequireCompleteType(Loc, PointeeTy,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005193 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_arithmetic_incomplete_type)
5194 << PExp->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005195 << PExp->getType()))
Steve Naroffaacd4cc2009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005196 return QualType();
5197 }
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005198 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00005199 if (PointeeTy->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005200 Diag(Loc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
5201 << PointeeTy << PExp->getSourceRange();
5202 return QualType();
5203 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005204
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005205 if (CompLHSTy) {
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +00005206 QualType LHSTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lex);
5207 if (LHSTy.isNull()) {
5208 LHSTy = lex->getType();
5209 if (LHSTy->isPromotableIntegerType())
5210 LHSTy = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(LHSTy);
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +00005211 }
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005212 *CompLHSTy = LHSTy;
5213 }
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005214 return PExp->getType();
5215 }
5216 }
5217
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005218 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00005219}
5220
Chris Lattner2a3569b2008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005221// C99 6.5.6
5222QualType Sema::CheckSubtractionOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex,
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005223 SourceLocation Loc, QualType* CompLHSTy) {
5224 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
5225 QualType compType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5226 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
5227 return compType;
5228 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005229
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005230 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, CompLHSTy);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005231
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005232 // Enforce type constraints: C99 6.5.6p3.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005233
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005234 // Handle the common case first (both operands are arithmetic).
Mike Stumpf70bcf72009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005235 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType()
5236 && rex->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005237 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005238 return compType;
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005239 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005240
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005241 // Either ptr - int or ptr - ptr.
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005242 if (lex->getType()->isAnyPointerType()) {
Steve Naroff4eed7a12009-07-13 17:19:15 +00005243 QualType lpointee = lex->getType()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005244
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005245 // The LHS must be an completely-defined object type.
Douglas Gregorf6cd9282009-01-23 00:36:41 +00005246
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005247 bool ComplainAboutVoid = false;
5248 Expr *ComplainAboutFunc = 0;
5249 if (lpointee->isVoidType()) {
5250 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5251 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
5252 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5253 return QualType();
5254 }
5255
5256 // GNU C extension: arithmetic on pointer to void
5257 ComplainAboutVoid = true;
5258 } else if (lpointee->isFunctionType()) {
5259 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5260 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005261 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005262 return QualType();
5263 }
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005264
5265 // GNU C extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5266 ComplainAboutFunc = lex;
5267 } else if (!lpointee->isDependentType() &&
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005268 RequireCompleteType(Loc, lpointee,
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005269 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_object)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005270 << lex->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005271 << lex->getType()))
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005272 return QualType();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005273
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005274 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00005275 if (lpointee->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005276 Diag(Loc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
5277 << lpointee << lex->getSourceRange();
5278 return QualType();
5279 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005280
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005281 // The result type of a pointer-int computation is the pointer type.
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005282 if (rex->getType()->isIntegerType()) {
5283 if (ComplainAboutVoid)
5284 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5285 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5286 if (ComplainAboutFunc)
5287 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005288 << ComplainAboutFunc->getType()
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005289 << ComplainAboutFunc->getSourceRange();
5290
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005291 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = lex->getType();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005292 return lex->getType();
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005293 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005294
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005295 // Handle pointer-pointer subtractions.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005296 if (const PointerType *RHSPTy = rex->getType()->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Eli Friedman1974e532008-02-08 01:19:44 +00005297 QualType rpointee = RHSPTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005298
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005299 // RHS must be a completely-type object type.
5300 // Handle the GNU void* extension.
5301 if (rpointee->isVoidType()) {
5302 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5303 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
5304 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5305 return QualType();
5306 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005307
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005308 ComplainAboutVoid = true;
5309 } else if (rpointee->isFunctionType()) {
5310 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5311 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005312 << rex->getType() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005313 return QualType();
5314 }
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005315
5316 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5317 if (!ComplainAboutFunc)
5318 ComplainAboutFunc = rex;
5319 } else if (!rpointee->isDependentType() &&
5320 RequireCompleteType(Loc, rpointee,
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005321 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_object)
5322 << rex->getSourceRange()
5323 << rex->getType()))
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005324 return QualType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005325
Eli Friedman168fe152009-05-16 13:54:38 +00005326 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5327 // Pointee types must be the same: C++ [expr.add]
5328 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(lpointee, rpointee)) {
5329 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_compatible)
5330 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
5331 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5332 return QualType();
5333 }
5334 } else {
5335 // Pointee types must be compatible C99 6.5.6p3
5336 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(
5337 Context.getCanonicalType(lpointee).getUnqualifiedType(),
5338 Context.getCanonicalType(rpointee).getUnqualifiedType())) {
5339 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_compatible)
5340 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
5341 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5342 return QualType();
5343 }
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005344 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005345
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005346 if (ComplainAboutVoid)
5347 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5348 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5349 if (ComplainAboutFunc)
5350 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005351 << ComplainAboutFunc->getType()
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005352 << ComplainAboutFunc->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005353
5354 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = lex->getType();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005355 return Context.getPointerDiffType();
5356 }
5357 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005358
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005359 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005360}
5361
Chris Lattner2a3569b2008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005362// C99 6.5.7
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005363QualType Sema::CheckShiftOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc,
Chris Lattner2a3569b2008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005364 bool isCompAssign) {
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005365 // C99 6.5.7p2: Each of the operands shall have integer type.
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00005366 if (!lex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation() ||
5367 !rex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation())
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005368 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005369
Nate Begemane46ee9a2009-10-25 02:26:48 +00005370 // Vector shifts promote their scalar inputs to vector type.
5371 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
5372 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5373
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005374 // Shifts don't perform usual arithmetic conversions, they just do integer
5375 // promotions on each operand. C99 6.5.7p3
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +00005376 QualType LHSTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lex);
5377 if (LHSTy.isNull()) {
5378 LHSTy = lex->getType();
5379 if (LHSTy->isPromotableIntegerType())
5380 LHSTy = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(LHSTy);
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +00005381 }
Chris Lattner3c133402007-12-13 07:28:16 +00005382 if (!isCompAssign)
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005383 ImpCastExprToType(lex, LHSTy, CK_IntegralCast);
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005384
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005385 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005386
Ryan Flynnf53fab82009-08-07 16:20:20 +00005387 // Sanity-check shift operands
5388 llvm::APSInt Right;
5389 // Check right/shifter operand
Daniel Dunbar687fa862009-09-17 06:31:27 +00005390 if (!rex->isValueDependent() &&
5391 rex->isIntegerConstantExpr(Right, Context)) {
Ryan Flynn2f085712009-08-08 19:18:23 +00005392 if (Right.isNegative())
Ryan Flynnf53fab82009-08-07 16:20:20 +00005393 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_shift_negative) << rex->getSourceRange();
5394 else {
5395 llvm::APInt LeftBits(Right.getBitWidth(),
5396 Context.getTypeSize(lex->getType()));
5397 if (Right.uge(LeftBits))
5398 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_shift_gt_typewidth) << rex->getSourceRange();
5399 }
5400 }
5401
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005402 // "The type of the result is that of the promoted left operand."
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005403 return LHSTy;
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00005404}
5405
Chandler Carruth17773fc2010-07-10 12:30:03 +00005406static bool IsWithinTemplateSpecialization(Decl *D) {
5407 if (DeclContext *DC = D->getDeclContext()) {
5408 if (isa<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(DC))
5409 return true;
5410 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(DC))
5411 return FD->isFunctionTemplateSpecialization();
5412 }
5413 return false;
5414}
5415
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005416// C99 6.5.8, C++ [expr.rel]
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005417QualType Sema::CheckCompareOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc,
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005418 unsigned OpaqueOpc, bool isRelational) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005419 BinaryOperatorKind Opc = (BinaryOperatorKind) OpaqueOpc;
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005420
Chris Lattner9a152e22009-12-05 05:40:13 +00005421 // Handle vector comparisons separately.
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005422 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005423 return CheckVectorCompareOperands(lex, rex, Loc, isRelational);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005424
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00005425 QualType lType = lex->getType();
5426 QualType rType = rex->getType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005427
Douglas Gregor4ffbad12010-06-22 22:12:46 +00005428 if (!lType->hasFloatingRepresentation() &&
5429 !(lType->isBlockPointerType() && isRelational)) {
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005430 // For non-floating point types, check for self-comparisons of the form
5431 // x == x, x != x, x < x, etc. These always evaluate to a constant, and
5432 // often indicate logic errors in the program.
Chandler Carruth65a38182010-07-12 06:23:38 +00005433 //
5434 // NOTE: Don't warn about comparison expressions resulting from macro
5435 // expansion. Also don't warn about comparisons which are only self
5436 // comparisons within a template specialization. The warnings should catch
5437 // obvious cases in the definition of the template anyways. The idea is to
5438 // warn when the typed comparison operator will always evaluate to the same
5439 // result.
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005440 Expr *LHSStripped = lex->IgnoreParens();
5441 Expr *RHSStripped = rex->IgnoreParens();
Chandler Carruth17773fc2010-07-10 12:30:03 +00005442 if (DeclRefExpr* DRL = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(LHSStripped)) {
Douglas Gregorec170db2010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005443 if (DeclRefExpr* DRR = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(RHSStripped)) {
Chandler Carruth65a38182010-07-12 06:23:38 +00005444 if (DRL->getDecl() == DRR->getDecl() && !Loc.isMacroID() &&
Chandler Carruth17773fc2010-07-10 12:30:03 +00005445 !IsWithinTemplateSpecialization(DRL->getDecl())) {
Douglas Gregorec170db2010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005446 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always)
5447 << 0 // self-
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005448 << (Opc == BO_EQ
5449 || Opc == BO_LE
5450 || Opc == BO_GE));
Douglas Gregorec170db2010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005451 } else if (lType->isArrayType() && rType->isArrayType() &&
5452 !DRL->getDecl()->getType()->isReferenceType() &&
5453 !DRR->getDecl()->getType()->isReferenceType()) {
5454 // what is it always going to eval to?
5455 char always_evals_to;
5456 switch(Opc) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005457 case BO_EQ: // e.g. array1 == array2
Douglas Gregorec170db2010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005458 always_evals_to = 0; // false
5459 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005460 case BO_NE: // e.g. array1 != array2
Douglas Gregorec170db2010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005461 always_evals_to = 1; // true
5462 break;
5463 default:
5464 // best we can say is 'a constant'
5465 always_evals_to = 2; // e.g. array1 <= array2
5466 break;
5467 }
5468 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always)
5469 << 1 // array
5470 << always_evals_to);
5471 }
5472 }
Chandler Carruth17773fc2010-07-10 12:30:03 +00005473 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005474
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005475 if (isa<CastExpr>(LHSStripped))
5476 LHSStripped = LHSStripped->IgnoreParenCasts();
5477 if (isa<CastExpr>(RHSStripped))
5478 RHSStripped = RHSStripped->IgnoreParenCasts();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005479
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005480 // Warn about comparisons against a string constant (unless the other
5481 // operand is null), the user probably wants strcmp.
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005482 Expr *literalString = 0;
5483 Expr *literalStringStripped = 0;
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005484 if ((isa<StringLiteral>(LHSStripped) || isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(LHSStripped)) &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005485 !RHSStripped->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005486 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005487 literalString = lex;
5488 literalStringStripped = LHSStripped;
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00005489 } else if ((isa<StringLiteral>(RHSStripped) ||
5490 isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(RHSStripped)) &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005491 !LHSStripped->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005492 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005493 literalString = rex;
5494 literalStringStripped = RHSStripped;
5495 }
5496
5497 if (literalString) {
5498 std::string resultComparison;
5499 switch (Opc) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005500 case BO_LT: resultComparison = ") < 0"; break;
5501 case BO_GT: resultComparison = ") > 0"; break;
5502 case BO_LE: resultComparison = ") <= 0"; break;
5503 case BO_GE: resultComparison = ") >= 0"; break;
5504 case BO_EQ: resultComparison = ") == 0"; break;
5505 case BO_NE: resultComparison = ") != 0"; break;
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005506 default: assert(false && "Invalid comparison operator");
5507 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005508
Douglas Gregor49862b82010-01-12 23:18:54 +00005509 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc,
5510 PDiag(diag::warn_stringcompare)
5511 << isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(literalStringStripped)
Ted Kremenek800b66b2010-04-09 20:26:53 +00005512 << literalString->getSourceRange());
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005513 }
Ted Kremeneke451eae2007-10-29 16:58:49 +00005514 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005515
Douglas Gregorec170db2010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005516 // C99 6.5.8p3 / C99 6.5.9p4
5517 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() && rex->getType()->isArithmeticType())
5518 UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex);
5519 else {
5520 UsualUnaryConversions(lex);
5521 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
5522 }
5523
5524 lType = lex->getType();
5525 rType = rex->getType();
5526
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005527 // The result of comparisons is 'bool' in C++, 'int' in C.
Chris Lattner9a152e22009-12-05 05:40:13 +00005528 QualType ResultTy = getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ? Context.BoolTy:Context.IntTy;
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005529
Chris Lattnerb620c342007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005530 if (isRelational) {
5531 if (lType->isRealType() && rType->isRealType())
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005532 return ResultTy;
Chris Lattnerb620c342007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005533 } else {
Ted Kremeneke2763b02007-10-29 17:13:39 +00005534 // Check for comparisons of floating point operands using != and ==.
Douglas Gregor4ffbad12010-06-22 22:12:46 +00005535 if (lType->hasFloatingRepresentation())
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005536 CheckFloatComparison(Loc,lex,rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005537
Chris Lattnerb620c342007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005538 if (lType->isArithmeticType() && rType->isArithmeticType())
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005539 return ResultTy;
Chris Lattnerb620c342007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005540 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005541
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005542 bool LHSIsNull = lex->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005543 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005544 bool RHSIsNull = rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005545 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005546
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005547 // All of the following pointer-related warnings are GCC extensions, except
5548 // when handling null pointer constants.
Steve Naroff808eb8f2007-08-27 04:08:11 +00005549 if (lType->isPointerType() && rType->isPointerType()) { // C99 6.5.8p2
Chris Lattner3a0702e2008-04-03 05:07:25 +00005550 QualType LCanPointeeTy =
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005551 Context.getCanonicalType(lType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
Chris Lattner3a0702e2008-04-03 05:07:25 +00005552 QualType RCanPointeeTy =
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005553 Context.getCanonicalType(rType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005554
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005555 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Eli Friedman16c209612009-08-23 00:27:47 +00005556 if (LCanPointeeTy == RCanPointeeTy)
5557 return ResultTy;
Fariborz Jahanianffc420c2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005558 if (!isRelational &&
5559 (LCanPointeeTy->isVoidType() || RCanPointeeTy->isVoidType())) {
5560 // Valid unless comparison between non-null pointer and function pointer
5561 // This is a gcc extension compatibility comparison.
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005562 // In a SFINAE context, we treat this as a hard error to maintain
5563 // conformance with the C++ standard.
Fariborz Jahanianffc420c2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005564 if ((LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType() || RCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType())
5565 && !LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005566 Diag(Loc,
5567 isSFINAEContext()?
5568 diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void
5569 : diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void)
Fariborz Jahanianffc420c2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005570 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005571
5572 if (isSFINAEContext())
5573 return QualType();
5574
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005575 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianffc420c2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005576 return ResultTy;
5577 }
5578 }
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005579 // C++ [expr.rel]p2:
5580 // [...] Pointer conversions (4.10) and qualification
5581 // conversions (4.4) are performed on pointer operands (or on
5582 // a pointer operand and a null pointer constant) to bring
5583 // them to their composite pointer type. [...]
5584 //
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005585 // C++ [expr.eq]p1 uses the same notion for (in)equality
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005586 // comparisons of pointers.
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005587 bool NonStandardCompositeType = false;
Douglas Gregor19175ff2010-04-16 23:20:25 +00005588 QualType T = FindCompositePointerType(Loc, lex, rex,
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005589 isSFINAEContext()? 0 : &NonStandardCompositeType);
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005590 if (T.isNull()) {
5591 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
5592 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5593 return QualType();
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005594 } else if (NonStandardCompositeType) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005595 Diag(Loc,
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005596 diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers_nonstandard)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005597 << lType << rType << T
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005598 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005599 }
5600
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005601 ImpCastExprToType(lex, T, CK_BitCast);
5602 ImpCastExprToType(rex, T, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005603 return ResultTy;
5604 }
Eli Friedman16c209612009-08-23 00:27:47 +00005605 // C99 6.5.9p2 and C99 6.5.8p2
5606 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(LCanPointeeTy.getUnqualifiedType(),
5607 RCanPointeeTy.getUnqualifiedType())) {
5608 // Valid unless a relational comparison of function pointers
5609 if (isRelational && LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
5610 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_function_pointers)
5611 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5612 }
5613 } else if (!isRelational &&
5614 (LCanPointeeTy->isVoidType() || RCanPointeeTy->isVoidType())) {
5615 // Valid unless comparison between non-null pointer and function pointer
5616 if ((LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType() || RCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType())
5617 && !LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
5618 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void)
5619 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5620 }
5621 } else {
5622 // Invalid
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005623 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005624 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff75c17232007-06-13 21:41:08 +00005625 }
Eli Friedman16c209612009-08-23 00:27:47 +00005626 if (LCanPointeeTy != RCanPointeeTy)
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005627 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005628 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffcdee44c2007-08-16 21:48:38 +00005629 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005630
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005631 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005632 // Comparison of pointers with null pointer constants and equality
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005633 // comparisons of member pointers to null pointer constants.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005634 if (RHSIsNull &&
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005635 (lType->isPointerType() ||
5636 (!isRelational && lType->isMemberPointerType()))) {
Douglas Gregorf58ff322010-08-07 13:36:37 +00005637 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType,
5638 lType->isMemberPointerType()
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005639 ? CK_NullToMemberPointer
5640 : CK_IntegralToPointer);
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005641 return ResultTy;
5642 }
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005643 if (LHSIsNull &&
5644 (rType->isPointerType() ||
5645 (!isRelational && rType->isMemberPointerType()))) {
Douglas Gregorf58ff322010-08-07 13:36:37 +00005646 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType,
5647 rType->isMemberPointerType()
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005648 ? CK_NullToMemberPointer
5649 : CK_IntegralToPointer);
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005650 return ResultTy;
5651 }
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005652
5653 // Comparison of member pointers.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005654 if (!isRelational &&
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005655 lType->isMemberPointerType() && rType->isMemberPointerType()) {
5656 // C++ [expr.eq]p2:
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005657 // In addition, pointers to members can be compared, or a pointer to
5658 // member and a null pointer constant. Pointer to member conversions
5659 // (4.11) and qualification conversions (4.4) are performed to bring
5660 // them to a common type. If one operand is a null pointer constant,
5661 // the common type is the type of the other operand. Otherwise, the
5662 // common type is a pointer to member type similar (4.4) to the type
5663 // of one of the operands, with a cv-qualification signature (4.4)
5664 // that is the union of the cv-qualification signatures of the operand
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005665 // types.
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005666 bool NonStandardCompositeType = false;
Douglas Gregor19175ff2010-04-16 23:20:25 +00005667 QualType T = FindCompositePointerType(Loc, lex, rex,
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005668 isSFINAEContext()? 0 : &NonStandardCompositeType);
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005669 if (T.isNull()) {
5670 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005671 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005672 return QualType();
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005673 } else if (NonStandardCompositeType) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005674 Diag(Loc,
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005675 diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers_nonstandard)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005676 << lType << rType << T
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005677 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005678 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005679
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005680 ImpCastExprToType(lex, T, CK_BitCast);
5681 ImpCastExprToType(rex, T, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005682 return ResultTy;
5683 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005684
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005685 // Comparison of nullptr_t with itself.
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005686 if (lType->isNullPtrType() && rType->isNullPtrType())
5687 return ResultTy;
5688 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005689
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005690 // Handle block pointer types.
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005691 if (!isRelational && lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()) {
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005692 QualType lpointee = lType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
5693 QualType rpointee = rType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005694
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005695 if (!LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull &&
Eli Friedmana6638ca2009-06-08 05:08:54 +00005696 !Context.typesAreCompatible(lpointee, rpointee)) {
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005697 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_blocks)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005698 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005699 }
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005700 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005701 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005702 }
Steve Naroffe18f94c2008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005703 // Allow block pointers to be compared with null pointer constants.
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005704 if (!isRelational
5705 && ((lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isPointerType())
5706 || (lType->isPointerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()))) {
Steve Naroffe18f94c2008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005707 if (!LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005708 if (!((rType->isPointerType() && rType->getAs<PointerType>()
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005709 ->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005710 || (lType->isPointerType() && lType->getAs<PointerType>()
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005711 ->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())))
5712 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_blocks)
5713 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffe18f94c2008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005714 }
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005715 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005716 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffe18f94c2008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005717 }
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005718
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005719 if ((lType->isObjCObjectPointerType() || rType->isObjCObjectPointerType())) {
Steve Naroff1d4a9a32008-10-27 10:33:19 +00005720 if (lType->isPointerType() || rType->isPointerType()) {
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005721 const PointerType *LPT = lType->getAs<PointerType>();
5722 const PointerType *RPT = rType->getAs<PointerType>();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005723 bool LPtrToVoid = LPT ?
Steve Naroff753567f2008-11-17 19:49:16 +00005724 Context.getCanonicalType(LPT->getPointeeType())->isVoidType() : false;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005725 bool RPtrToVoid = RPT ?
Steve Naroff753567f2008-11-17 19:49:16 +00005726 Context.getCanonicalType(RPT->getPointeeType())->isVoidType() : false;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005727
Steve Naroff753567f2008-11-17 19:49:16 +00005728 if (!LPtrToVoid && !RPtrToVoid &&
5729 !Context.typesAreCompatible(lType, rType)) {
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005730 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005731 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff1d4a9a32008-10-27 10:33:19 +00005732 }
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005733 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005734 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffea54d9e2008-10-20 18:19:10 +00005735 }
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005736 if (lType->isObjCObjectPointerType() && rType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Chris Lattnerf8344db2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005737 if (!Context.areComparableObjCPointerTypes(lType, rType))
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005738 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
5739 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005740 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005741 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffb788d9b2008-06-03 14:04:54 +00005742 }
Fariborz Jahanian134cbef2007-12-20 01:06:58 +00005743 }
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005744 if ((lType->isAnyPointerType() && rType->isIntegerType()) ||
5745 (lType->isIntegerType() && rType->isAnyPointerType())) {
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005746 unsigned DiagID = 0;
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005747 bool isError = false;
5748 if ((LHSIsNull && lType->isIntegerType()) ||
5749 (RHSIsNull && rType->isIntegerType())) {
5750 if (isRelational && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005751 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_and_zero;
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005752 } else if (isRelational && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005753 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005754 else if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5755 DiagID = diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
5756 isError = true;
5757 } else
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005758 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005759
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005760 if (DiagID) {
Chris Lattnerf8344db2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005761 Diag(Loc, DiagID)
Chris Lattnerd466ea12009-06-30 06:24:05 +00005762 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005763 if (isError)
5764 return QualType();
Chris Lattnerf8344db2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005765 }
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005766
5767 if (lType->isIntegerType())
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005768 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType, CK_IntegralToPointer);
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005769 else
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005770 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005771 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00005772 }
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005773
Steve Naroff4b191572008-09-04 16:56:14 +00005774 // Handle block pointers.
Mike Stumpf70bcf72009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005775 if (!isRelational && RHSIsNull
5776 && lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isIntegerType()) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005777 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005778 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff4b191572008-09-04 16:56:14 +00005779 }
Mike Stumpf70bcf72009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005780 if (!isRelational && LHSIsNull
5781 && lType->isIntegerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005782 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType, CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005783 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff4b191572008-09-04 16:56:14 +00005784 }
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005785 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00005786}
5787
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005788/// CheckVectorCompareOperands - vector comparisons are a clang extension that
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005789/// operates on extended vector types. Instead of producing an IntTy result,
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005790/// like a scalar comparison, a vector comparison produces a vector of integer
5791/// types.
5792QualType Sema::CheckVectorCompareOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex,
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005793 SourceLocation Loc,
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005794 bool isRelational) {
5795 // Check to make sure we're operating on vectors of the same type and width,
5796 // Allowing one side to be a scalar of element type.
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005797 QualType vType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005798 if (vType.isNull())
5799 return vType;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005800
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005801 QualType lType = lex->getType();
5802 QualType rType = rex->getType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005803
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005804 // For non-floating point types, check for self-comparisons of the form
5805 // x == x, x != x, x < x, etc. These always evaluate to a constant, and
5806 // often indicate logic errors in the program.
Douglas Gregor4ffbad12010-06-22 22:12:46 +00005807 if (!lType->hasFloatingRepresentation()) {
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005808 if (DeclRefExpr* DRL = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(lex->IgnoreParens()))
5809 if (DeclRefExpr* DRR = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(rex->IgnoreParens()))
5810 if (DRL->getDecl() == DRR->getDecl())
Douglas Gregorec170db2010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005811 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc,
5812 PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always)
5813 << 0 // self-
5814 << 2 // "a constant"
5815 );
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005816 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005817
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005818 // Check for comparisons of floating point operands using != and ==.
Douglas Gregor4ffbad12010-06-22 22:12:46 +00005819 if (!isRelational && lType->hasFloatingRepresentation()) {
5820 assert (rType->hasFloatingRepresentation());
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005821 CheckFloatComparison(Loc,lex,rex);
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005822 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005823
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005824 // Return the type for the comparison, which is the same as vector type for
5825 // integer vectors, or an integer type of identical size and number of
5826 // elements for floating point vectors.
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00005827 if (lType->hasIntegerRepresentation())
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005828 return lType;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005829
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005830 const VectorType *VTy = lType->getAs<VectorType>();
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005831 unsigned TypeSize = Context.getTypeSize(VTy->getElementType());
Nate Begeman2f2bdeb2009-01-18 03:20:47 +00005832 if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.IntTy))
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005833 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.IntTy, VTy->getNumElements());
Chris Lattner5d688962009-03-31 07:46:52 +00005834 if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.LongTy))
Nate Begeman2f2bdeb2009-01-18 03:20:47 +00005835 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.LongTy, VTy->getNumElements());
5836
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005837 assert(TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.LongLongTy) &&
Nate Begeman2f2bdeb2009-01-18 03:20:47 +00005838 "Unhandled vector element size in vector compare");
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005839 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.LongLongTy, VTy->getNumElements());
5840}
5841
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005842inline QualType Sema::CheckBitwiseOperands(
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005843 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign) {
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00005844 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
5845 if (lex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation() &&
5846 rex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation())
5847 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5848
5849 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5850 }
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005851
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005852 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005853
Steve Naroffdbd9e892007-07-17 00:58:39 +00005854 if (lex->getType()->isIntegerType() && rex->getType()->isIntegerType())
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005855 return compType;
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005856 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00005857}
5858
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005859inline QualType Sema::CheckLogicalOperands( // C99 6.5.[13,14]
Chris Lattner8406c512010-07-13 19:41:32 +00005860 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, unsigned Opc) {
5861
5862 // Diagnose cases where the user write a logical and/or but probably meant a
5863 // bitwise one. We do this when the LHS is a non-bool integer and the RHS
5864 // is a constant.
5865 if (lex->getType()->isIntegerType() && !lex->getType()->isBooleanType() &&
Eli Friedman6b197e02010-07-27 19:14:53 +00005866 rex->getType()->isIntegerType() && !rex->isValueDependent() &&
Chris Lattnerdeee7a32010-07-15 00:26:43 +00005867 // Don't warn in macros.
Chris Lattner938533d2010-07-24 01:10:11 +00005868 !Loc.isMacroID()) {
5869 // If the RHS can be constant folded, and if it constant folds to something
5870 // that isn't 0 or 1 (which indicate a potential logical operation that
5871 // happened to fold to true/false) then warn.
5872 Expr::EvalResult Result;
5873 if (rex->Evaluate(Result, Context) && !Result.HasSideEffects &&
5874 Result.Val.getInt() != 0 && Result.Val.getInt() != 1) {
5875 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_logical_instead_of_bitwise)
5876 << rex->getSourceRange()
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005877 << (Opc == BO_LAnd ? "&&" : "||")
5878 << (Opc == BO_LAnd ? "&" : "|");
Chris Lattner938533d2010-07-24 01:10:11 +00005879 }
5880 }
Chris Lattner8406c512010-07-13 19:41:32 +00005881
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005882 if (!Context.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5883 UsualUnaryConversions(lex);
5884 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005885
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005886 if (!lex->getType()->isScalarType() || !rex->getType()->isScalarType())
5887 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005888
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005889 return Context.IntTy;
Anders Carlsson35a99d92009-10-16 01:44:21 +00005890 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005891
John McCall4a2429a2010-06-04 00:29:51 +00005892 // The following is safe because we only use this method for
5893 // non-overloadable operands.
5894
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005895 // C++ [expr.log.and]p1
5896 // C++ [expr.log.or]p1
John McCall4a2429a2010-06-04 00:29:51 +00005897 // The operands are both contextually converted to type bool.
5898 if (PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(lex) ||
5899 PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(rex))
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005900 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005901
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005902 // C++ [expr.log.and]p2
5903 // C++ [expr.log.or]p2
5904 // The result is a bool.
5905 return Context.BoolTy;
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00005906}
5907
Fariborz Jahanian8e1555c2009-01-12 19:55:42 +00005908/// IsReadonlyProperty - Verify that otherwise a valid l-value expression
5909/// is a read-only property; return true if so. A readonly property expression
5910/// depends on various declarations and thus must be treated specially.
5911///
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005912static bool IsReadonlyProperty(Expr *E, Sema &S) {
Fariborz Jahanian8e1555c2009-01-12 19:55:42 +00005913 if (E->getStmtClass() == Expr::ObjCPropertyRefExprClass) {
5914 const ObjCPropertyRefExpr* PropExpr = cast<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(E);
5915 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PDecl = PropExpr->getProperty()) {
5916 QualType BaseType = PropExpr->getBase()->getType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005917 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005918 BaseType->getAsObjCInterfacePointerType())
5919 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = OPT->getInterfaceDecl())
5920 if (S.isPropertyReadonly(PDecl, IFace))
5921 return true;
Fariborz Jahanian8e1555c2009-01-12 19:55:42 +00005922 }
5923 }
5924 return false;
5925}
5926
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005927/// CheckForModifiableLvalue - Verify that E is a modifiable lvalue. If not,
5928/// emit an error and return true. If so, return false.
5929static bool CheckForModifiableLvalue(Expr *E, SourceLocation Loc, Sema &S) {
Daniel Dunbarc2223ab2009-04-15 00:08:05 +00005930 SourceLocation OrigLoc = Loc;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005931 Expr::isModifiableLvalueResult IsLV = E->isModifiableLvalue(S.Context,
Daniel Dunbarc2223ab2009-04-15 00:08:05 +00005932 &Loc);
Fariborz Jahanian8e1555c2009-01-12 19:55:42 +00005933 if (IsLV == Expr::MLV_Valid && IsReadonlyProperty(E, S))
5934 IsLV = Expr::MLV_ReadonlyProperty;
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005935 if (IsLV == Expr::MLV_Valid)
5936 return false;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005937
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005938 unsigned Diag = 0;
5939 bool NeedType = false;
5940 switch (IsLV) { // C99 6.5.16p2
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005941 case Expr::MLV_ConstQualified: Diag = diag::err_typecheck_assign_const; break;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005942 case Expr::MLV_ArrayType:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005943 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_array_not_modifiable_lvalue;
5944 NeedType = true;
5945 break;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005946 case Expr::MLV_NotObjectType:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005947 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_non_object_not_modifiable_lvalue;
5948 NeedType = true;
5949 break;
Chris Lattner9b3bbe92008-11-17 19:51:54 +00005950 case Expr::MLV_LValueCast:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005951 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_lvalue_casts_not_supported;
5952 break;
Douglas Gregorb154fdc2010-02-16 21:39:57 +00005953 case Expr::MLV_Valid:
5954 llvm_unreachable("did not take early return for MLV_Valid");
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005955 case Expr::MLV_InvalidExpression:
Douglas Gregorb154fdc2010-02-16 21:39:57 +00005956 case Expr::MLV_MemberFunction:
5957 case Expr::MLV_ClassTemporary:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005958 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_expression_not_modifiable_lvalue;
5959 break;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005960 case Expr::MLV_IncompleteType:
5961 case Expr::MLV_IncompleteVoidType:
Douglas Gregored0cfbd2009-03-09 16:13:40 +00005962 return S.RequireCompleteType(Loc, E->getType(),
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00005963 S.PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_type_not_modifiable_lvalue)
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00005964 << E->getSourceRange());
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005965 case Expr::MLV_DuplicateVectorComponents:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005966 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_duplicate_vector_components_not_mlvalue;
5967 break;
Steve Naroffba756cb2008-09-26 14:41:28 +00005968 case Expr::MLV_NotBlockQualified:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005969 Diag = diag::err_block_decl_ref_not_modifiable_lvalue;
5970 break;
Fariborz Jahanian8a1810f2008-11-22 18:39:36 +00005971 case Expr::MLV_ReadonlyProperty:
5972 Diag = diag::error_readonly_property_assignment;
5973 break;
Fariborz Jahanian5118c412008-11-22 20:25:50 +00005974 case Expr::MLV_NoSetterProperty:
5975 Diag = diag::error_nosetter_property_assignment;
5976 break;
Fariborz Jahaniane8d28902009-12-15 23:59:41 +00005977 case Expr::MLV_SubObjCPropertySetting:
5978 Diag = diag::error_no_subobject_property_setting;
5979 break;
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005980 }
Steve Naroffad373bd2007-07-31 12:34:36 +00005981
Daniel Dunbarc2223ab2009-04-15 00:08:05 +00005982 SourceRange Assign;
5983 if (Loc != OrigLoc)
5984 Assign = SourceRange(OrigLoc, OrigLoc);
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005985 if (NeedType)
Daniel Dunbarc2223ab2009-04-15 00:08:05 +00005986 S.Diag(Loc, Diag) << E->getType() << E->getSourceRange() << Assign;
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005987 else
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005988 S.Diag(Loc, Diag) << E->getSourceRange() << Assign;
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005989 return true;
5990}
5991
5992
5993
5994// C99 6.5.16.1
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005995QualType Sema::CheckAssignmentOperands(Expr *LHS, Expr *&RHS,
5996 SourceLocation Loc,
5997 QualType CompoundType) {
5998 // Verify that LHS is a modifiable lvalue, and emit error if not.
5999 if (CheckForModifiableLvalue(LHS, Loc, *this))
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006000 return QualType();
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006001
6002 QualType LHSType = LHS->getType();
6003 QualType RHSType = CompoundType.isNull() ? RHS->getType() : CompoundType;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006004 AssignConvertType ConvTy;
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006005 if (CompoundType.isNull()) {
Fariborz Jahanianbe21aa32010-06-07 22:02:01 +00006006 QualType LHSTy(LHSType);
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006007 // Simple assignment "x = y".
Fariborz Jahanianbe21aa32010-06-07 22:02:01 +00006008 if (const ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr *OISGE =
6009 dyn_cast<ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr>(LHS)) {
6010 // If using property-dot syntax notation for assignment, and there is a
6011 // setter, RHS expression is being passed to the setter argument. So,
6012 // type conversion (and comparison) is RHS to setter's argument type.
6013 if (const ObjCMethodDecl *SetterMD = OISGE->getSetterMethod()) {
6014 ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator P = SetterMD->param_begin();
6015 LHSTy = (*P)->getType();
6016 }
6017 }
6018
6019 ConvTy = CheckSingleAssignmentConstraints(LHSTy, RHS);
Fariborz Jahanian255c0952009-01-13 23:34:40 +00006020 // Special case of NSObject attributes on c-style pointer types.
6021 if (ConvTy == IncompatiblePointer &&
6022 ((Context.isObjCNSObjectType(LHSType) &&
Steve Naroff79d12152009-07-16 15:41:00 +00006023 RHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) ||
Fariborz Jahanian255c0952009-01-13 23:34:40 +00006024 (Context.isObjCNSObjectType(RHSType) &&
Steve Naroff79d12152009-07-16 15:41:00 +00006025 LHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType())))
Fariborz Jahanian255c0952009-01-13 23:34:40 +00006026 ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006027
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006028 // If the RHS is a unary plus or minus, check to see if they = and + are
6029 // right next to each other. If so, the user may have typo'd "x =+ 4"
6030 // instead of "x += 4".
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006031 Expr *RHSCheck = RHS;
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006032 if (ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(RHSCheck))
6033 RHSCheck = ICE->getSubExpr();
6034 if (UnaryOperator *UO = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(RHSCheck)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006035 if ((UO->getOpcode() == UO_Plus ||
6036 UO->getOpcode() == UO_Minus) &&
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006037 Loc.isFileID() && UO->getOperatorLoc().isFileID() &&
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006038 // Only if the two operators are exactly adjacent.
Chris Lattner36c39c92009-03-08 06:51:10 +00006039 Loc.getFileLocWithOffset(1) == UO->getOperatorLoc() &&
6040 // And there is a space or other character before the subexpr of the
6041 // unary +/-. We don't want to warn on "x=-1".
Chris Lattnered9f14c2009-03-09 07:11:10 +00006042 Loc.getFileLocWithOffset(2) != UO->getSubExpr()->getLocStart() &&
6043 UO->getSubExpr()->getLocStart().isFileID()) {
Chris Lattner29e812b2008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006044 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_compound_assign)
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006045 << (UO->getOpcode() == UO_Plus ? "+" : "-")
Chris Lattner29e812b2008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006046 << SourceRange(UO->getOperatorLoc(), UO->getOperatorLoc());
Chris Lattner36c39c92009-03-08 06:51:10 +00006047 }
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006048 }
6049 } else {
6050 // Compound assignment "x += y"
Eli Friedmanb05c41e2009-05-16 05:56:02 +00006051 ConvTy = CheckAssignmentConstraints(LHSType, RHSType);
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006052 }
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006053
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006054 if (DiagnoseAssignmentResult(ConvTy, Loc, LHSType, RHSType,
Douglas Gregor7c3bbdf2009-12-16 03:45:30 +00006055 RHS, AA_Assigning))
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006056 return QualType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006057
Chris Lattner39561062010-07-07 06:14:23 +00006058
6059 // Check to see if the destination operand is a dereferenced null pointer. If
6060 // so, and if not volatile-qualified, this is undefined behavior that the
6061 // optimizer will delete, so warn about it. People sometimes try to use this
6062 // to get a deterministic trap and are surprised by clang's behavior. This
6063 // only handles the pattern "*null = whatever", which is a very syntactic
6064 // check.
6065 if (UnaryOperator *UO = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(LHS->IgnoreParenCasts()))
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006066 if (UO->getOpcode() == UO_Deref &&
Chris Lattner39561062010-07-07 06:14:23 +00006067 UO->getSubExpr()->IgnoreParenCasts()->
6068 isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull) &&
6069 !UO->getType().isVolatileQualified()) {
6070 Diag(UO->getOperatorLoc(), diag::warn_indirection_through_null)
6071 << UO->getSubExpr()->getSourceRange();
6072 Diag(UO->getOperatorLoc(), diag::note_indirection_through_null);
6073 }
6074
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00006075 // C99 6.5.16p3: The type of an assignment expression is the type of the
6076 // left operand unless the left operand has qualified type, in which case
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006077 // it is the unqualified version of the type of the left operand.
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00006078 // C99 6.5.16.1p2: In simple assignment, the value of the right operand
6079 // is converted to the type of the assignment expression (above).
Chris Lattnerf17bd422007-08-30 17:45:32 +00006080 // C++ 5.17p1: the type of the assignment expression is that of its left
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +00006081 // operand.
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006082 return LHSType.getUnqualifiedType();
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00006083}
6084
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006085// C99 6.5.17
6086QualType Sema::CheckCommaOperands(Expr *LHS, Expr *&RHS, SourceLocation Loc) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis639ffb02010-06-30 10:53:14 +00006087 DiagnoseUnusedExprResult(LHS);
6088
Chris Lattnerf6e1e302008-07-25 20:54:07 +00006089 // Comma performs lvalue conversion (C99 6.3.2.1), but not unary conversions.
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00006090 // C++ does not perform this conversion (C++ [expr.comma]p1).
6091 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
6092 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHS);
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00006093
6094 // FIXME: Check that RHS type is complete in C mode (it's legal for it to be
6095 // incomplete in C++).
6096
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006097 return RHS->getType();
Steve Naroff95af0132007-03-30 23:47:58 +00006098}
6099
Steve Naroff7a5af782007-07-13 16:58:59 +00006100/// CheckIncrementDecrementOperand - unlike most "Check" methods, this routine
6101/// doesn't need to call UsualUnaryConversions or UsualArithmeticConversions.
Sebastian Redle10c2c32008-12-20 09:35:34 +00006102QualType Sema::CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(Expr *Op, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00006103 bool isInc, bool isPrefix) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006104 if (Op->isTypeDependent())
6105 return Context.DependentTy;
6106
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006107 QualType ResType = Op->getType();
6108 assert(!ResType.isNull() && "no type for increment/decrement expression");
Steve Naroffd50c88e2007-04-05 21:15:20 +00006109
Sebastian Redle10c2c32008-12-20 09:35:34 +00006110 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && ResType->isBooleanType()) {
6111 // Decrement of bool is not allowed.
6112 if (!isInc) {
6113 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_decrement_bool) << Op->getSourceRange();
6114 return QualType();
6115 }
6116 // Increment of bool sets it to true, but is deprecated.
6117 Diag(OpLoc, diag::warn_increment_bool) << Op->getSourceRange();
6118 } else if (ResType->isRealType()) {
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006119 // OK!
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00006120 } else if (ResType->isAnyPointerType()) {
6121 QualType PointeeTy = ResType->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006122
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006123 // C99 6.5.2.4p2, 6.5.6p2
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006124 if (PointeeTy->isVoidType()) {
Douglas Gregorf6cd9282009-01-23 00:36:41 +00006125 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
6126 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
6127 << Op->getSourceRange();
6128 return QualType();
6129 }
6130
6131 // Pointer to void is a GNU extension in C.
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006132 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr) << Op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006133 } else if (PointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
Douglas Gregorf6cd9282009-01-23 00:36:41 +00006134 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
6135 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
6136 << Op->getType() << Op->getSourceRange();
6137 return QualType();
6138 }
6139
6140 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00006141 << ResType << Op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006142 } else if (RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, PointeeTy,
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00006143 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_arithmetic_incomplete_type)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006144 << Op->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00006145 << ResType))
Douglas Gregordd430f72009-01-19 19:26:10 +00006146 return QualType();
Fariborz Jahanianca75db72009-07-16 17:59:14 +00006147 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006148 else if (PointeeTy->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Fariborz Jahanianca75db72009-07-16 17:59:14 +00006149 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
6150 << PointeeTy << Op->getSourceRange();
6151 return QualType();
6152 }
Eli Friedman090addd2010-01-03 00:20:48 +00006153 } else if (ResType->isAnyComplexType()) {
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006154 // C99 does not support ++/-- on complex types, we allow as an extension.
6155 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_integer_increment_complex)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00006156 << ResType << Op->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006157 } else {
6158 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_illegal_increment_decrement)
Douglas Gregor906db8a2009-12-15 16:44:32 +00006159 << ResType << int(isInc) << Op->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006160 return QualType();
Steve Naroff46ba1eb2007-04-03 23:13:13 +00006161 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006162 // At this point, we know we have a real, complex or pointer type.
Steve Naroff9e1e5512007-08-23 21:37:33 +00006163 // Now make sure the operand is a modifiable lvalue.
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006164 if (CheckForModifiableLvalue(Op, OpLoc, *this))
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006165 return QualType();
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00006166 // In C++, a prefix increment is the same type as the operand. Otherwise
6167 // (in C or with postfix), the increment is the unqualified type of the
6168 // operand.
6169 return isPrefix && getLangOptions().CPlusPlus
6170 ? ResType : ResType.getUnqualifiedType();
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00006171}
6172
Anders Carlsson806700f2008-02-01 07:15:58 +00006173/// getPrimaryDecl - Helper function for CheckAddressOfOperand().
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006174/// This routine allows us to typecheck complex/recursive expressions
Daniel Dunbarb692ef42008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006175/// where the declaration is needed for type checking. We only need to
6176/// handle cases when the expression references a function designator
6177/// or is an lvalue. Here are some examples:
6178/// - &(x) => x
6179/// - &*****f => f for f a function designator.
6180/// - &s.xx => s
6181/// - &s.zz[1].yy -> s, if zz is an array
6182/// - *(x + 1) -> x, if x is an array
6183/// - &"123"[2] -> 0
6184/// - & __real__ x -> x
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006185static NamedDecl *getPrimaryDecl(Expr *E) {
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006186 switch (E->getStmtClass()) {
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006187 case Stmt::DeclRefExprClass:
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006188 return cast<DeclRefExpr>(E)->getDecl();
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006189 case Stmt::MemberExprClass:
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006190 // If this is an arrow operator, the address is an offset from
6191 // the base's value, so the object the base refers to is
6192 // irrelevant.
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006193 if (cast<MemberExpr>(E)->isArrow())
Chris Lattner48d52842007-11-16 17:46:48 +00006194 return 0;
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006195 // Otherwise, the expression refers to a part of the base
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006196 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<MemberExpr>(E)->getBase());
Anders Carlsson806700f2008-02-01 07:15:58 +00006197 case Stmt::ArraySubscriptExprClass: {
Mike Stump87c57ac2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00006198 // FIXME: This code shouldn't be necessary! We should catch the implicit
6199 // promotion of register arrays earlier.
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006200 Expr* Base = cast<ArraySubscriptExpr>(E)->getBase();
6201 if (ImplicitCastExpr* ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(Base)) {
6202 if (ICE->getSubExpr()->getType()->isArrayType())
6203 return getPrimaryDecl(ICE->getSubExpr());
6204 }
6205 return 0;
Anders Carlsson806700f2008-02-01 07:15:58 +00006206 }
Daniel Dunbarb692ef42008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006207 case Stmt::UnaryOperatorClass: {
6208 UnaryOperator *UO = cast<UnaryOperator>(E);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006209
Daniel Dunbarb692ef42008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006210 switch(UO->getOpcode()) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006211 case UO_Real:
6212 case UO_Imag:
6213 case UO_Extension:
Daniel Dunbarb692ef42008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006214 return getPrimaryDecl(UO->getSubExpr());
6215 default:
6216 return 0;
6217 }
6218 }
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006219 case Stmt::ParenExprClass:
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006220 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<ParenExpr>(E)->getSubExpr());
Chris Lattner48d52842007-11-16 17:46:48 +00006221 case Stmt::ImplicitCastExprClass:
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006222 // If the result of an implicit cast is an l-value, we care about
6223 // the sub-expression; otherwise, the result here doesn't matter.
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006224 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E)->getSubExpr());
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006225 default:
6226 return 0;
6227 }
6228}
6229
6230/// CheckAddressOfOperand - The operand of & must be either a function
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006231/// designator or an lvalue designating an object. If it is an lvalue, the
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006232/// object cannot be declared with storage class register or be a bit field.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006233/// Note: The usual conversions are *not* applied to the operand of the &
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00006234/// operator (C99 6.3.2.1p[2-4]), and its result is never an lvalue.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006235/// In C++, the operand might be an overloaded function name, in which case
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00006236/// we allow the '&' but retain the overloaded-function type.
John McCall8d08b9b2010-08-27 09:08:28 +00006237QualType Sema::CheckAddressOfOperand(Expr *OrigOp, SourceLocation OpLoc) {
6238 if (OrigOp->isTypeDependent())
Douglas Gregor19b8c4f2008-12-17 22:52:20 +00006239 return Context.DependentTy;
John McCall8d08b9b2010-08-27 09:08:28 +00006240 if (OrigOp->getType() == Context.OverloadTy)
6241 return Context.OverloadTy;
6242
6243 // Make sure to ignore parentheses in subsequent checks
6244 Expr *op = OrigOp->IgnoreParens();
Douglas Gregor19b8c4f2008-12-17 22:52:20 +00006245
Steve Naroff826e91a2008-01-13 17:10:08 +00006246 if (getLangOptions().C99) {
6247 // Implement C99-only parts of addressof rules.
6248 if (UnaryOperator* uOp = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(op)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006249 if (uOp->getOpcode() == UO_Deref)
Steve Naroff826e91a2008-01-13 17:10:08 +00006250 // Per C99 6.5.3.2, the address of a deref always returns a valid result
6251 // (assuming the deref expression is valid).
6252 return uOp->getSubExpr()->getType();
6253 }
6254 // Technically, there should be a check for array subscript
6255 // expressions here, but the result of one is always an lvalue anyway.
6256 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006257 NamedDecl *dcl = getPrimaryDecl(op);
Chris Lattner67315442008-07-26 21:30:36 +00006258 Expr::isLvalueResult lval = op->isLvalue(Context);
Nuno Lopes17f345f2008-12-16 22:59:47 +00006259
Chris Lattner9156f1b2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006260 if (lval == Expr::LV_ClassTemporary) {
Douglas Gregorb154fdc2010-02-16 21:39:57 +00006261 Diag(OpLoc, isSFINAEContext()? diag::err_typecheck_addrof_class_temporary
6262 : diag::ext_typecheck_addrof_class_temporary)
6263 << op->getType() << op->getSourceRange();
6264 if (isSFINAEContext())
6265 return QualType();
John McCall8d08b9b2010-08-27 09:08:28 +00006266 } else if (isa<ObjCSelectorExpr>(op)) {
Chris Lattner9156f1b2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006267 return Context.getPointerType(op->getType());
John McCall8d08b9b2010-08-27 09:08:28 +00006268 } else if (lval == Expr::LV_MemberFunction) {
6269 // If it's an instance method, make a member pointer.
6270 // The expression must have exactly the form &A::foo.
6271
6272 // If the underlying expression isn't a decl ref, give up.
6273 if (!isa<DeclRefExpr>(op)) {
6274 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_invalid_form_pointer_member_function)
6275 << OrigOp->getSourceRange();
6276 return QualType();
6277 }
6278 DeclRefExpr *DRE = cast<DeclRefExpr>(op);
6279 CXXMethodDecl *MD = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DRE->getDecl());
6280
6281 // The id-expression was parenthesized.
6282 if (OrigOp != DRE) {
6283 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_parens_pointer_member_function)
6284 << OrigOp->getSourceRange();
6285
6286 // The method was named without a qualifier.
6287 } else if (!DRE->getQualifier()) {
6288 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_unqualified_pointer_member_function)
6289 << op->getSourceRange();
6290 }
6291
6292 return Context.getMemberPointerType(op->getType(),
6293 Context.getTypeDeclType(MD->getParent()).getTypePtr());
6294 } else if (lval != Expr::LV_Valid && lval != Expr::LV_IncompleteVoidType) {
Eli Friedmance7f9002009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006295 // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006296 // The operand must be either an l-value or a function designator
Eli Friedmance7f9002009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006297 if (!op->getType()->isFunctionType()) {
Chris Lattner48d52842007-11-16 17:46:48 +00006298 // FIXME: emit more specific diag...
Chris Lattnerf490e152008-11-19 05:27:50 +00006299 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_invalid_lvalue_addrof)
6300 << op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006301 return QualType();
6302 }
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00006303 } else if (op->getBitField()) { // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006304 // The operand cannot be a bit-field
6305 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6306 << "bit-field" << op->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor2eedc3a2008-12-20 23:49:58 +00006307 return QualType();
Anders Carlsson8abde4b2010-01-31 17:18:49 +00006308 } else if (op->refersToVectorElement()) {
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006309 // The operand cannot be an element of a vector
Chris Lattner29e812b2008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006310 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
Nate Begemana6b47a42009-02-15 22:45:20 +00006311 << "vector element" << op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffb96e4ab62008-02-29 23:30:25 +00006312 return QualType();
Fariborz Jahanian385db802009-07-07 18:50:52 +00006313 } else if (isa<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(op)) {
6314 // cannot take address of a property expression.
6315 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6316 << "property expression" << op->getSourceRange();
6317 return QualType();
Anders Carlsson3fa58d12009-09-14 23:15:26 +00006318 } else if (ConditionalOperator *CO = dyn_cast<ConditionalOperator>(op)) {
6319 // FIXME: Can LHS ever be null here?
Anders Carlsson01ccf992009-09-15 16:03:44 +00006320 if (!CheckAddressOfOperand(CO->getTrueExpr(), OpLoc).isNull())
6321 return CheckAddressOfOperand(CO->getFalseExpr(), OpLoc);
Steve Naroffb96e4ab62008-02-29 23:30:25 +00006322 } else if (dcl) { // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006323 // We have an lvalue with a decl. Make sure the decl is not declared
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006324 // with the register storage-class specifier.
6325 if (const VarDecl *vd = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(dcl)) {
Fariborz Jahaniane0fd5a92010-08-24 22:21:48 +00006326 // in C++ it is not error to take address of a register
6327 // variable (c++03 7.1.1P3)
John McCall8e7d6562010-08-26 03:08:43 +00006328 if (vd->getStorageClass() == SC_Register &&
Fariborz Jahaniane0fd5a92010-08-24 22:21:48 +00006329 !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Chris Lattner29e812b2008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006330 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6331 << "register variable" << op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006332 return QualType();
6333 }
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00006334 } else if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(dcl)) {
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00006335 return Context.OverloadTy;
Anders Carlsson0b675f52009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006336 } else if (FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(dcl)) {
Douglas Gregor9aa8b552008-12-10 21:26:49 +00006337 // Okay: we can take the address of a field.
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006338 // Could be a pointer to member, though, if there is an explicit
6339 // scope qualifier for the class.
Douglas Gregor4bd90e52009-10-23 18:54:35 +00006340 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(op) && cast<DeclRefExpr>(op)->getQualifier()) {
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006341 DeclContext *Ctx = dcl->getDeclContext();
Anders Carlsson0b675f52009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006342 if (Ctx && Ctx->isRecord()) {
6343 if (FD->getType()->isReferenceType()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006344 Diag(OpLoc,
Anders Carlsson0b675f52009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006345 diag::err_cannot_form_pointer_to_member_of_reference_type)
6346 << FD->getDeclName() << FD->getType();
6347 return QualType();
6348 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006349
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006350 return Context.getMemberPointerType(op->getType(),
6351 Context.getTypeDeclType(cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx)).getTypePtr());
Anders Carlsson0b675f52009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006352 }
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006353 }
Anders Carlsson5b535762009-05-16 21:43:42 +00006354 } else if (!isa<FunctionDecl>(dcl))
Steve Narofff633d092007-04-25 19:01:39 +00006355 assert(0 && "Unknown/unexpected decl type");
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006356 }
Sebastian Redl18f8ff62009-02-04 21:23:32 +00006357
Eli Friedmance7f9002009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006358 if (lval == Expr::LV_IncompleteVoidType) {
6359 // Taking the address of a void variable is technically illegal, but we
6360 // allow it in cases which are otherwise valid.
6361 // Example: "extern void x; void* y = &x;".
6362 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_typecheck_addrof_void) << op->getSourceRange();
6363 }
6364
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006365 // If the operand has type "type", the result has type "pointer to type".
Douglas Gregor0bdcb8a2010-07-29 16:05:45 +00006366 if (op->getType()->isObjCObjectType())
6367 return Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(op->getType());
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006368 return Context.getPointerType(op->getType());
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006369}
6370
Chris Lattner9156f1b2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006371/// CheckIndirectionOperand - Type check unary indirection (prefix '*').
Chris Lattner6a2ed6f2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00006372QualType Sema::CheckIndirectionOperand(Expr *Op, SourceLocation OpLoc) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006373 if (Op->isTypeDependent())
6374 return Context.DependentTy;
6375
Chris Lattner6a2ed6f2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00006376 UsualUnaryConversions(Op);
Chris Lattner9156f1b2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006377 QualType OpTy = Op->getType();
6378 QualType Result;
6379
6380 // Note that per both C89 and C99, indirection is always legal, even if OpTy
6381 // is an incomplete type or void. It would be possible to warn about
6382 // dereferencing a void pointer, but it's completely well-defined, and such a
6383 // warning is unlikely to catch any mistakes.
6384 if (const PointerType *PT = OpTy->getAs<PointerType>())
6385 Result = PT->getPointeeType();
6386 else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
6387 OpTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>())
6388 Result = OPT->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006389
Chris Lattner9156f1b2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006390 if (Result.isNull()) {
6391 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_indirection_requires_pointer)
6392 << OpTy << Op->getSourceRange();
6393 return QualType();
6394 }
6395
6396 return Result;
Steve Naroff1926c832007-04-24 00:23:05 +00006397}
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006398
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006399static inline BinaryOperatorKind ConvertTokenKindToBinaryOpcode(
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006400 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006401 BinaryOperatorKind Opc;
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006402 switch (Kind) {
6403 default: assert(0 && "Unknown binop!");
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006404 case tok::periodstar: Opc = BO_PtrMemD; break;
6405 case tok::arrowstar: Opc = BO_PtrMemI; break;
6406 case tok::star: Opc = BO_Mul; break;
6407 case tok::slash: Opc = BO_Div; break;
6408 case tok::percent: Opc = BO_Rem; break;
6409 case tok::plus: Opc = BO_Add; break;
6410 case tok::minus: Opc = BO_Sub; break;
6411 case tok::lessless: Opc = BO_Shl; break;
6412 case tok::greatergreater: Opc = BO_Shr; break;
6413 case tok::lessequal: Opc = BO_LE; break;
6414 case tok::less: Opc = BO_LT; break;
6415 case tok::greaterequal: Opc = BO_GE; break;
6416 case tok::greater: Opc = BO_GT; break;
6417 case tok::exclaimequal: Opc = BO_NE; break;
6418 case tok::equalequal: Opc = BO_EQ; break;
6419 case tok::amp: Opc = BO_And; break;
6420 case tok::caret: Opc = BO_Xor; break;
6421 case tok::pipe: Opc = BO_Or; break;
6422 case tok::ampamp: Opc = BO_LAnd; break;
6423 case tok::pipepipe: Opc = BO_LOr; break;
6424 case tok::equal: Opc = BO_Assign; break;
6425 case tok::starequal: Opc = BO_MulAssign; break;
6426 case tok::slashequal: Opc = BO_DivAssign; break;
6427 case tok::percentequal: Opc = BO_RemAssign; break;
6428 case tok::plusequal: Opc = BO_AddAssign; break;
6429 case tok::minusequal: Opc = BO_SubAssign; break;
6430 case tok::lesslessequal: Opc = BO_ShlAssign; break;
6431 case tok::greatergreaterequal: Opc = BO_ShrAssign; break;
6432 case tok::ampequal: Opc = BO_AndAssign; break;
6433 case tok::caretequal: Opc = BO_XorAssign; break;
6434 case tok::pipeequal: Opc = BO_OrAssign; break;
6435 case tok::comma: Opc = BO_Comma; break;
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006436 }
6437 return Opc;
6438}
6439
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006440static inline UnaryOperatorKind ConvertTokenKindToUnaryOpcode(
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006441 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006442 UnaryOperatorKind Opc;
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006443 switch (Kind) {
6444 default: assert(0 && "Unknown unary op!");
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006445 case tok::plusplus: Opc = UO_PreInc; break;
6446 case tok::minusminus: Opc = UO_PreDec; break;
6447 case tok::amp: Opc = UO_AddrOf; break;
6448 case tok::star: Opc = UO_Deref; break;
6449 case tok::plus: Opc = UO_Plus; break;
6450 case tok::minus: Opc = UO_Minus; break;
6451 case tok::tilde: Opc = UO_Not; break;
6452 case tok::exclaim: Opc = UO_LNot; break;
6453 case tok::kw___real: Opc = UO_Real; break;
6454 case tok::kw___imag: Opc = UO_Imag; break;
6455 case tok::kw___extension__: Opc = UO_Extension; break;
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006456 }
6457 return Opc;
6458}
6459
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006460/// CreateBuiltinBinOp - Creates a new built-in binary operation with
6461/// operator @p Opc at location @c TokLoc. This routine only supports
6462/// built-in operations; ActOnBinOp handles overloaded operators.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006463ExprResult Sema::CreateBuiltinBinOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006464 unsigned Op,
6465 Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs) {
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006466 QualType ResultTy; // Result type of the binary operator.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006467 BinaryOperatorKind Opc = (BinaryOperatorKind) Op;
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006468 // The following two variables are used for compound assignment operators
6469 QualType CompLHSTy; // Type of LHS after promotions for computation
6470 QualType CompResultTy; // Type of computation result
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006471
6472 switch (Opc) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006473 case BO_Assign:
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006474 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, QualType());
6475 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006476 case BO_PtrMemD:
6477 case BO_PtrMemI:
Sebastian Redl112a97662009-02-07 00:15:38 +00006478 ResultTy = CheckPointerToMemberOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006479 Opc == BO_PtrMemI);
Sebastian Redl112a97662009-02-07 00:15:38 +00006480 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006481 case BO_Mul:
6482 case BO_Div:
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00006483 ResultTy = CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, false,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006484 Opc == BO_Div);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006485 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006486 case BO_Rem:
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006487 ResultTy = CheckRemainderOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6488 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006489 case BO_Add:
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006490 ResultTy = CheckAdditionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6491 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006492 case BO_Sub:
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006493 ResultTy = CheckSubtractionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6494 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006495 case BO_Shl:
6496 case BO_Shr:
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006497 ResultTy = CheckShiftOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6498 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006499 case BO_LE:
6500 case BO_LT:
6501 case BO_GE:
6502 case BO_GT:
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00006503 ResultTy = CheckCompareOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, Opc, true);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006504 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006505 case BO_EQ:
6506 case BO_NE:
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00006507 ResultTy = CheckCompareOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, Opc, false);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006508 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006509 case BO_And:
6510 case BO_Xor:
6511 case BO_Or:
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006512 ResultTy = CheckBitwiseOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6513 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006514 case BO_LAnd:
6515 case BO_LOr:
Chris Lattner8406c512010-07-13 19:41:32 +00006516 ResultTy = CheckLogicalOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, Opc);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006517 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006518 case BO_MulAssign:
6519 case BO_DivAssign:
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00006520 CompResultTy = CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006521 Opc == BO_DivAssign);
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006522 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6523 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6524 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006525 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006526 case BO_RemAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006527 CompResultTy = CheckRemainderOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
6528 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6529 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6530 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006531 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006532 case BO_AddAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006533 CompResultTy = CheckAdditionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, &CompLHSTy);
6534 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6535 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006536 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006537 case BO_SubAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006538 CompResultTy = CheckSubtractionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, &CompLHSTy);
6539 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6540 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006541 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006542 case BO_ShlAssign:
6543 case BO_ShrAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006544 CompResultTy = CheckShiftOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
6545 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6546 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6547 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006548 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006549 case BO_AndAssign:
6550 case BO_XorAssign:
6551 case BO_OrAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006552 CompResultTy = CheckBitwiseOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
6553 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6554 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6555 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006556 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006557 case BO_Comma:
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006558 ResultTy = CheckCommaOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6559 break;
6560 }
6561 if (ResultTy.isNull())
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00006562 return ExprError();
Fariborz Jahanian99311ba2010-08-16 21:51:12 +00006563 if (ResultTy->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006564 if (Opc >= BO_Assign && Opc <= BO_OrAssign)
Fariborz Jahanian99311ba2010-08-16 21:51:12 +00006565 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_assignment_requires_nonfragile_object)
6566 << ResultTy;
6567 }
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006568 if (CompResultTy.isNull())
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00006569 return Owned(new (Context) BinaryOperator(lhs, rhs, Opc, ResultTy, OpLoc));
6570 else
6571 return Owned(new (Context) CompoundAssignOperator(lhs, rhs, Opc, ResultTy,
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006572 CompLHSTy, CompResultTy,
6573 OpLoc));
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006574}
6575
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006576/// SuggestParentheses - Emit a diagnostic together with a fixit hint that wraps
6577/// ParenRange in parentheses.
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006578static void SuggestParentheses(Sema &Self, SourceLocation Loc,
6579 const PartialDiagnostic &PD,
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006580 const PartialDiagnostic &FirstNote,
6581 SourceRange FirstParenRange,
6582 const PartialDiagnostic &SecondNote,
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006583 SourceRange SecondParenRange) {
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006584 Self.Diag(Loc, PD);
6585
6586 if (!FirstNote.getDiagID())
6587 return;
6588
6589 SourceLocation EndLoc = Self.PP.getLocForEndOfToken(FirstParenRange.getEnd());
6590 if (!FirstParenRange.getEnd().isFileID() || EndLoc.isInvalid()) {
6591 // We can't display the parentheses, so just return.
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006592 return;
6593 }
6594
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006595 Self.Diag(Loc, FirstNote)
6596 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(FirstParenRange.getBegin(), "(")
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00006597 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(EndLoc, ")");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006598
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006599 if (!SecondNote.getDiagID())
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006600 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006601
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006602 EndLoc = Self.PP.getLocForEndOfToken(SecondParenRange.getEnd());
6603 if (!SecondParenRange.getEnd().isFileID() || EndLoc.isInvalid()) {
6604 // We can't display the parentheses, so just dig the
6605 // warning/error and return.
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006606 Self.Diag(Loc, SecondNote);
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006607 return;
6608 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006609
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006610 Self.Diag(Loc, SecondNote)
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00006611 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(SecondParenRange.getBegin(), "(")
6612 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(EndLoc, ")");
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006613}
6614
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006615/// DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence - Emit a warning when bitwise and comparison
6616/// operators are mixed in a way that suggests that the programmer forgot that
6617/// comparison operators have higher precedence. The most typical example of
6618/// such code is "flags & 0x0020 != 0", which is equivalent to "flags & 1".
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006619static void DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence(Sema &Self, BinaryOperatorKind Opc,
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006620 SourceLocation OpLoc,Expr *lhs,Expr *rhs){
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006621 typedef BinaryOperator BinOp;
6622 BinOp::Opcode lhsopc = static_cast<BinOp::Opcode>(-1),
6623 rhsopc = static_cast<BinOp::Opcode>(-1);
6624 if (BinOp *BO = dyn_cast<BinOp>(lhs))
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006625 lhsopc = BO->getOpcode();
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006626 if (BinOp *BO = dyn_cast<BinOp>(rhs))
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006627 rhsopc = BO->getOpcode();
6628
6629 // Subs are not binary operators.
6630 if (lhsopc == -1 && rhsopc == -1)
6631 return;
6632
6633 // Bitwise operations are sometimes used as eager logical ops.
6634 // Don't diagnose this.
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006635 if ((BinOp::isComparisonOp(lhsopc) || BinOp::isBitwiseOp(lhsopc)) &&
6636 (BinOp::isComparisonOp(rhsopc) || BinOp::isBitwiseOp(rhsopc)))
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006637 return;
6638
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006639 if (BinOp::isComparisonOp(lhsopc))
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006640 SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc,
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006641 Self.PDiag(diag::warn_precedence_bitwise_rel)
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006642 << SourceRange(lhs->getLocStart(), OpLoc)
6643 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc) << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(lhsopc),
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006644 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_first)
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006645 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc),
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006646 SourceRange(cast<BinOp>(lhs)->getRHS()->getLocStart(), rhs->getLocEnd()),
6647 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_silence)
6648 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(lhsopc),
6649 lhs->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006650 else if (BinOp::isComparisonOp(rhsopc))
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006651 SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc,
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006652 Self.PDiag(diag::warn_precedence_bitwise_rel)
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006653 << SourceRange(OpLoc, rhs->getLocEnd())
6654 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc) << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(rhsopc),
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006655 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_first)
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006656 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc),
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006657 SourceRange(lhs->getLocEnd(), cast<BinOp>(rhs)->getLHS()->getLocStart()),
6658 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_silence)
6659 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(rhsopc),
6660 rhs->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006661}
6662
6663/// DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence - Emit warnings for expressions with tricky
6664/// precedence. This currently diagnoses only "arg1 'bitwise' arg2 'eq' arg3".
6665/// But it could also warn about arg1 && arg2 || arg3, as GCC 4.3+ does.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006666static void DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence(Sema &Self, BinaryOperatorKind Opc,
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006667 SourceLocation OpLoc, Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs){
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006668 if (BinaryOperator::isBitwiseOp(Opc))
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006669 DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence(Self, Opc, OpLoc, lhs, rhs);
6670}
6671
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006672// Binary Operators. 'Tok' is the token for the operator.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006673ExprResult Sema::ActOnBinOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation TokLoc,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006674 tok::TokenKind Kind,
6675 Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs) {
6676 BinaryOperatorKind Opc = ConvertTokenKindToBinaryOpcode(Kind);
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00006677 assert((lhs != 0) && "ActOnBinOp(): missing left expression");
6678 assert((rhs != 0) && "ActOnBinOp(): missing right expression");
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006679
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006680 // Emit warnings for tricky precedence issues, e.g. "bitfield & 0x4 == 0"
6681 DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence(*this, Opc, TokLoc, lhs, rhs);
6682
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006683 return BuildBinOp(S, TokLoc, Opc, lhs, rhs);
6684}
6685
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006686ExprResult Sema::BuildBinOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006687 BinaryOperatorKind Opc,
6688 Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs) {
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006689 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006690 (lhs->getType()->isOverloadableType() ||
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006691 rhs->getType()->isOverloadableType())) {
6692 // Find all of the overloaded operators visible from this
6693 // point. We perform both an operator-name lookup from the local
6694 // scope and an argument-dependent lookup based on the types of
6695 // the arguments.
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006696 UnresolvedSet<16> Functions;
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006697 OverloadedOperatorKind OverOp = BinaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006698 if (S && OverOp != OO_None)
6699 LookupOverloadedOperatorName(OverOp, S, lhs->getType(), rhs->getType(),
6700 Functions);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006701
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006702 // Build the (potentially-overloaded, potentially-dependent)
6703 // binary operation.
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006704 return CreateOverloadedBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Functions, lhs, rhs);
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00006705 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006706
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006707 // Build a built-in binary operation.
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006708 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, lhs, rhs);
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006709}
6710
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006711ExprResult Sema::CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006712 unsigned OpcIn,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00006713 Expr *Input) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006714 UnaryOperatorKind Opc = static_cast<UnaryOperatorKind>(OpcIn);
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006715
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006716 QualType resultType;
6717 switch (Opc) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006718 case UO_PreInc:
6719 case UO_PreDec:
6720 case UO_PostInc:
6721 case UO_PostDec:
Sebastian Redle10c2c32008-12-20 09:35:34 +00006722 resultType = CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(Input, OpLoc,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006723 Opc == UO_PreInc ||
6724 Opc == UO_PostInc,
6725 Opc == UO_PreInc ||
6726 Opc == UO_PreDec);
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006727 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006728 case UO_AddrOf:
Chris Lattner86554282007-06-08 22:32:33 +00006729 resultType = CheckAddressOfOperand(Input, OpLoc);
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006730 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006731 case UO_Deref:
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00006732 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Input);
Chris Lattner86554282007-06-08 22:32:33 +00006733 resultType = CheckIndirectionOperand(Input, OpLoc);
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006734 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006735 case UO_Plus:
6736 case UO_Minus:
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00006737 UsualUnaryConversions(Input);
6738 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006739 if (resultType->isDependentType())
6740 break;
Douglas Gregora3208f92010-06-22 23:41:02 +00006741 if (resultType->isArithmeticType() || // C99 6.5.3.3p1
6742 resultType->isVectorType())
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006743 break;
6744 else if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && // C++ [expr.unary.op]p6-7
6745 resultType->isEnumeralType())
6746 break;
6747 else if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && // C++ [expr.unary.op]p6
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006748 Opc == UO_Plus &&
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006749 resultType->isPointerType())
6750 break;
6751
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006752 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
6753 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006754 case UO_Not: // bitwise complement
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00006755 UsualUnaryConversions(Input);
6756 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006757 if (resultType->isDependentType())
6758 break;
Chris Lattner0d707612008-07-25 23:52:49 +00006759 // C99 6.5.3.3p1. We allow complex int and float as a GCC extension.
6760 if (resultType->isComplexType() || resultType->isComplexIntegerType())
6761 // C99 does not support '~' for complex conjugation.
Chris Lattner29e812b2008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006762 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_integer_complement_complex)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00006763 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00006764 else if (!resultType->hasIntegerRepresentation())
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006765 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
6766 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006767 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006768 case UO_LNot: // logical negation
Steve Naroff71b59a92007-06-04 22:22:31 +00006769 // Unlike +/-/~, integer promotions aren't done here (C99 6.5.3.3p5).
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00006770 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Input);
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00006771 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006772 if (resultType->isDependentType())
6773 break;
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006774 if (!resultType->isScalarType()) // C99 6.5.3.3p1
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006775 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
6776 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
Chris Lattnerbe31ed82007-06-02 19:11:33 +00006777 // LNot always has type int. C99 6.5.3.3p5.
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006778 // In C++, it's bool. C++ 5.3.1p8
6779 resultType = getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ? Context.BoolTy : Context.IntTy;
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006780 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006781 case UO_Real:
6782 case UO_Imag:
6783 resultType = CheckRealImagOperand(Input, OpLoc, Opc == UO_Real);
Chris Lattner30b5dd02007-08-24 21:16:53 +00006784 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006785 case UO_Extension:
Chris Lattner86554282007-06-08 22:32:33 +00006786 resultType = Input->getType();
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00006787 break;
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006788 }
6789 if (resultType.isNull())
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006790 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006791
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00006792 return Owned(new (Context) UnaryOperator(Input, Opc, resultType, OpLoc));
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006793}
Chris Lattnereefa10e2007-05-28 06:56:27 +00006794
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006795ExprResult Sema::BuildUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006796 UnaryOperatorKind Opc,
6797 Expr *Input) {
Anders Carlsson461a2c02009-11-14 21:26:41 +00006798 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && Input->getType()->isOverloadableType() &&
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006799 Opc != UO_Extension) {
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006800 // Find all of the overloaded operators visible from this
6801 // point. We perform both an operator-name lookup from the local
6802 // scope and an argument-dependent lookup based on the types of
6803 // the arguments.
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006804 UnresolvedSet<16> Functions;
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006805 OverloadedOperatorKind OverOp = UnaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006806 if (S && OverOp != OO_None)
6807 LookupOverloadedOperatorName(OverOp, S, Input->getType(), QualType(),
6808 Functions);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006809
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00006810 return CreateOverloadedUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Functions, Input);
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006811 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006812
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00006813 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Input);
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006814}
6815
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006816// Unary Operators. 'Tok' is the token for the operator.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006817ExprResult Sema::ActOnUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00006818 tok::TokenKind Op, Expr *Input) {
6819 return BuildUnaryOp(S, OpLoc, ConvertTokenKindToUnaryOpcode(Op), Input);
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006820}
6821
Steve Naroff66356bd2007-09-16 14:56:35 +00006822/// ActOnAddrLabel - Parse the GNU address of label extension: "&&foo".
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006823ExprResult Sema::ActOnAddrLabel(SourceLocation OpLoc,
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006824 SourceLocation LabLoc,
6825 IdentifierInfo *LabelII) {
Chris Lattnereefa10e2007-05-28 06:56:27 +00006826 // Look up the record for this label identifier.
John McCallaab3e412010-08-25 08:40:02 +00006827 LabelStmt *&LabelDecl = getCurFunction()->LabelMap[LabelII];
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006828
Daniel Dunbar88402ce2008-08-04 16:51:22 +00006829 // If we haven't seen this label yet, create a forward reference. It
6830 // will be validated and/or cleaned up in ActOnFinishFunctionBody.
Steve Naroff846b1ec2009-03-13 15:38:40 +00006831 if (LabelDecl == 0)
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00006832 LabelDecl = new (Context) LabelStmt(LabLoc, LabelII, 0);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006833
Chris Lattnereefa10e2007-05-28 06:56:27 +00006834 // Create the AST node. The address of a label always has type 'void*'.
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006835 return Owned(new (Context) AddrLabelExpr(OpLoc, LabLoc, LabelDecl,
6836 Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy)));
Chris Lattnereefa10e2007-05-28 06:56:27 +00006837}
6838
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006839ExprResult
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00006840Sema::ActOnStmtExpr(SourceLocation LPLoc, Stmt *SubStmt,
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006841 SourceLocation RPLoc) { // "({..})"
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006842 assert(SubStmt && isa<CompoundStmt>(SubStmt) && "Invalid action invocation!");
6843 CompoundStmt *Compound = cast<CompoundStmt>(SubStmt);
6844
Douglas Gregor6cf3f3c2010-03-10 04:54:39 +00006845 bool isFileScope
6846 = (getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl() == 0) && (getCurBlock() == 0);
Chris Lattnera69b0762009-04-25 19:11:05 +00006847 if (isFileScope)
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006848 return ExprError(Diag(LPLoc, diag::err_stmtexpr_file_scope));
Eli Friedman52cc0162009-01-24 23:09:00 +00006849
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006850 // FIXME: there are a variety of strange constraints to enforce here, for
6851 // example, it is not possible to goto into a stmt expression apparently.
6852 // More semantic analysis is needed.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006853
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006854 // If there are sub stmts in the compound stmt, take the type of the last one
6855 // as the type of the stmtexpr.
6856 QualType Ty = Context.VoidTy;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006857
Chris Lattner944d3062008-07-26 19:51:01 +00006858 if (!Compound->body_empty()) {
6859 Stmt *LastStmt = Compound->body_back();
6860 // If LastStmt is a label, skip down through into the body.
6861 while (LabelStmt *Label = dyn_cast<LabelStmt>(LastStmt))
6862 LastStmt = Label->getSubStmt();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006863
Chris Lattner944d3062008-07-26 19:51:01 +00006864 if (Expr *LastExpr = dyn_cast<Expr>(LastStmt))
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006865 Ty = LastExpr->getType();
Chris Lattner944d3062008-07-26 19:51:01 +00006866 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006867
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00006868 // FIXME: Check that expression type is complete/non-abstract; statement
6869 // expressions are not lvalues.
6870
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006871 return Owned(new (Context) StmtExpr(Compound, Ty, LPLoc, RPLoc));
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006872}
Steve Naroff78864672007-08-01 22:05:33 +00006873
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006874ExprResult Sema::BuildBuiltinOffsetOf(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006875 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006876 OffsetOfComponent *CompPtr,
6877 unsigned NumComponents,
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006878 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
6879 QualType ArgTy = TInfo->getType();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006880 bool Dependent = ArgTy->isDependentType();
Abramo Bagnara1108e7b2010-05-20 10:00:11 +00006881 SourceRange TypeRange = TInfo->getTypeLoc().getLocalSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006882
Chris Lattnerf17bd422007-08-30 17:45:32 +00006883 // We must have at least one component that refers to the type, and the first
6884 // one is known to be a field designator. Verify that the ArgTy represents
6885 // a struct/union/class.
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006886 if (!Dependent && !ArgTy->isRecordType())
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006887 return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_offsetof_record_type)
6888 << ArgTy << TypeRange);
6889
6890 // Type must be complete per C99 7.17p3 because a declaring a variable
6891 // with an incomplete type would be ill-formed.
6892 if (!Dependent
6893 && RequireCompleteType(BuiltinLoc, ArgTy,
6894 PDiag(diag::err_offsetof_incomplete_type)
6895 << TypeRange))
6896 return ExprError();
6897
Chris Lattner78502cf2007-08-31 21:49:13 +00006898 // offsetof with non-identifier designators (e.g. "offsetof(x, a.b[c])") are a
6899 // GCC extension, diagnose them.
Eli Friedman988a16b2009-02-27 06:44:11 +00006900 // FIXME: This diagnostic isn't actually visible because the location is in
6901 // a system header!
Chris Lattner78502cf2007-08-31 21:49:13 +00006902 if (NumComponents != 1)
Chris Lattnerf490e152008-11-19 05:27:50 +00006903 Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::ext_offsetof_extended_field_designator)
6904 << SourceRange(CompPtr[1].LocStart, CompPtr[NumComponents-1].LocEnd);
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006905
6906 bool DidWarnAboutNonPOD = false;
6907 QualType CurrentType = ArgTy;
6908 typedef OffsetOfExpr::OffsetOfNode OffsetOfNode;
6909 llvm::SmallVector<OffsetOfNode, 4> Comps;
6910 llvm::SmallVector<Expr*, 4> Exprs;
6911 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumComponents; ++i) {
6912 const OffsetOfComponent &OC = CompPtr[i];
6913 if (OC.isBrackets) {
6914 // Offset of an array sub-field. TODO: Should we allow vector elements?
6915 if (!CurrentType->isDependentType()) {
6916 const ArrayType *AT = Context.getAsArrayType(CurrentType);
6917 if(!AT)
6918 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_array_type)
6919 << CurrentType);
6920 CurrentType = AT->getElementType();
6921 } else
6922 CurrentType = Context.DependentTy;
6923
6924 // The expression must be an integral expression.
6925 // FIXME: An integral constant expression?
6926 Expr *Idx = static_cast<Expr*>(OC.U.E);
6927 if (!Idx->isTypeDependent() && !Idx->isValueDependent() &&
6928 !Idx->getType()->isIntegerType())
6929 return ExprError(Diag(Idx->getLocStart(),
6930 diag::err_typecheck_subscript_not_integer)
6931 << Idx->getSourceRange());
6932
6933 // Record this array index.
6934 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, Exprs.size(), OC.LocEnd));
6935 Exprs.push_back(Idx);
6936 continue;
6937 }
6938
6939 // Offset of a field.
6940 if (CurrentType->isDependentType()) {
6941 // We have the offset of a field, but we can't look into the dependent
6942 // type. Just record the identifier of the field.
6943 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, OC.U.IdentInfo, OC.LocEnd));
6944 CurrentType = Context.DependentTy;
6945 continue;
6946 }
6947
6948 // We need to have a complete type to look into.
6949 if (RequireCompleteType(OC.LocStart, CurrentType,
6950 diag::err_offsetof_incomplete_type))
6951 return ExprError();
6952
6953 // Look for the designated field.
6954 const RecordType *RC = CurrentType->getAs<RecordType>();
6955 if (!RC)
6956 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_record_type)
6957 << CurrentType);
6958 RecordDecl *RD = RC->getDecl();
6959
6960 // C++ [lib.support.types]p5:
6961 // The macro offsetof accepts a restricted set of type arguments in this
6962 // International Standard. type shall be a POD structure or a POD union
6963 // (clause 9).
6964 if (CXXRecordDecl *CRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD)) {
6965 if (!CRD->isPOD() && !DidWarnAboutNonPOD &&
6966 DiagRuntimeBehavior(BuiltinLoc,
6967 PDiag(diag::warn_offsetof_non_pod_type)
6968 << SourceRange(CompPtr[0].LocStart, OC.LocEnd)
6969 << CurrentType))
6970 DidWarnAboutNonPOD = true;
6971 }
6972
6973 // Look for the field.
6974 LookupResult R(*this, OC.U.IdentInfo, OC.LocStart, LookupMemberName);
6975 LookupQualifiedName(R, RD);
6976 FieldDecl *MemberDecl = R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>();
6977 if (!MemberDecl)
6978 return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_no_member)
6979 << OC.U.IdentInfo << RD << SourceRange(OC.LocStart,
6980 OC.LocEnd));
6981
Douglas Gregor10982ea2010-04-28 22:36:06 +00006982 // C99 7.17p3:
6983 // (If the specified member is a bit-field, the behavior is undefined.)
6984 //
6985 // We diagnose this as an error.
6986 if (MemberDecl->getBitWidth()) {
6987 Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_bitfield)
6988 << MemberDecl->getDeclName()
6989 << SourceRange(BuiltinLoc, RParenLoc);
6990 Diag(MemberDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_bitfield_decl);
6991 return ExprError();
6992 }
Eli Friedman74ef7cf2010-08-05 10:11:36 +00006993
6994 RecordDecl *Parent = MemberDecl->getParent();
6995 bool AnonStructUnion = Parent->isAnonymousStructOrUnion();
6996 if (AnonStructUnion) {
6997 do {
6998 Parent = cast<RecordDecl>(Parent->getParent());
6999 } while (Parent->isAnonymousStructOrUnion());
7000 }
7001
Douglas Gregord1702062010-04-29 00:18:15 +00007002 // If the member was found in a base class, introduce OffsetOfNodes for
7003 // the base class indirections.
7004 CXXBasePaths Paths(/*FindAmbiguities=*/true, /*RecordPaths=*/true,
7005 /*DetectVirtual=*/false);
Eli Friedman74ef7cf2010-08-05 10:11:36 +00007006 if (IsDerivedFrom(CurrentType, Context.getTypeDeclType(Parent), Paths)) {
Douglas Gregord1702062010-04-29 00:18:15 +00007007 CXXBasePath &Path = Paths.front();
7008 for (CXXBasePath::iterator B = Path.begin(), BEnd = Path.end();
7009 B != BEnd; ++B)
7010 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(B->Base));
7011 }
Eli Friedman74ef7cf2010-08-05 10:11:36 +00007012
7013 if (AnonStructUnion) {
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007014 llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl*, 4> Path;
7015 BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(MemberDecl, Path);
7016 unsigned n = Path.size();
7017 for (int j = n - 1; j > -1; --j)
7018 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, Path[j], OC.LocEnd));
7019 } else {
7020 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, MemberDecl, OC.LocEnd));
7021 }
7022 CurrentType = MemberDecl->getType().getNonReferenceType();
7023 }
7024
7025 return Owned(OffsetOfExpr::Create(Context, Context.getSizeType(), BuiltinLoc,
7026 TInfo, Comps.data(), Comps.size(),
7027 Exprs.data(), Exprs.size(), RParenLoc));
7028}
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007029
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007030ExprResult Sema::ActOnBuiltinOffsetOf(Scope *S,
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007031 SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
7032 SourceLocation TypeLoc,
John McCallba7bf592010-08-24 05:47:05 +00007033 ParsedType argty,
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007034 OffsetOfComponent *CompPtr,
7035 unsigned NumComponents,
7036 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
7037
7038 TypeSourceInfo *ArgTInfo;
7039 QualType ArgTy = GetTypeFromParser(argty, &ArgTInfo);
7040 if (ArgTy.isNull())
7041 return ExprError();
7042
Eli Friedman06dcfd92010-08-05 10:15:45 +00007043 if (!ArgTInfo)
7044 ArgTInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(ArgTy, TypeLoc);
7045
7046 return BuildBuiltinOffsetOf(BuiltinLoc, ArgTInfo, CompPtr, NumComponents,
7047 RPLoc);
Chris Lattnerf17bd422007-08-30 17:45:32 +00007048}
7049
7050
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007051ExprResult Sema::ActOnTypesCompatibleExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
John McCallba7bf592010-08-24 05:47:05 +00007052 ParsedType arg1,ParsedType arg2,
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007053 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Abramo Bagnara092990a2010-08-10 08:50:03 +00007054 TypeSourceInfo *argTInfo1;
7055 QualType argT1 = GetTypeFromParser(arg1, &argTInfo1);
7056 TypeSourceInfo *argTInfo2;
7057 QualType argT2 = GetTypeFromParser(arg2, &argTInfo2);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007058
Steve Naroff78864672007-08-01 22:05:33 +00007059 assert((!argT1.isNull() && !argT2.isNull()) && "Missing type argument(s)");
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007060
Abramo Bagnara092990a2010-08-10 08:50:03 +00007061 return BuildTypesCompatibleExpr(BuiltinLoc, argTInfo1, argTInfo2, RPLoc);
7062}
7063
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007064ExprResult
Abramo Bagnara092990a2010-08-10 08:50:03 +00007065Sema::BuildTypesCompatibleExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
7066 TypeSourceInfo *argTInfo1,
7067 TypeSourceInfo *argTInfo2,
7068 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Douglas Gregorf907cbf2009-05-19 22:28:02 +00007069 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
7070 Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_types_compatible_p_in_cplusplus)
7071 << SourceRange(BuiltinLoc, RPLoc);
7072 return ExprError();
7073 }
7074
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007075 return Owned(new (Context) TypesCompatibleExpr(Context.IntTy, BuiltinLoc,
Abramo Bagnara092990a2010-08-10 08:50:03 +00007076 argTInfo1, argTInfo2, RPLoc));
Steve Naroff78864672007-08-01 22:05:33 +00007077}
7078
Abramo Bagnara092990a2010-08-10 08:50:03 +00007079
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007080ExprResult Sema::ActOnChooseExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007081 Expr *CondExpr,
7082 Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr,
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007083 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Steve Naroff9efdabc2007-08-03 21:21:27 +00007084 assert((CondExpr && LHSExpr && RHSExpr) && "Missing type argument(s)");
7085
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007086 QualType resType;
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00007087 bool ValueDependent = false;
Douglas Gregor0df91122009-05-19 22:43:30 +00007088 if (CondExpr->isTypeDependent() || CondExpr->isValueDependent()) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007089 resType = Context.DependentTy;
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00007090 ValueDependent = true;
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007091 } else {
7092 // The conditional expression is required to be a constant expression.
7093 llvm::APSInt condEval(32);
7094 SourceLocation ExpLoc;
7095 if (!CondExpr->isIntegerConstantExpr(condEval, Context, &ExpLoc))
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007096 return ExprError(Diag(ExpLoc,
7097 diag::err_typecheck_choose_expr_requires_constant)
7098 << CondExpr->getSourceRange());
Steve Naroff9efdabc2007-08-03 21:21:27 +00007099
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007100 // If the condition is > zero, then the AST type is the same as the LSHExpr.
7101 resType = condEval.getZExtValue() ? LHSExpr->getType() : RHSExpr->getType();
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00007102 ValueDependent = condEval.getZExtValue() ? LHSExpr->isValueDependent()
7103 : RHSExpr->isValueDependent();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007104 }
7105
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007106 return Owned(new (Context) ChooseExpr(BuiltinLoc, CondExpr, LHSExpr, RHSExpr,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00007107 resType, RPLoc,
7108 resType->isDependentType(),
7109 ValueDependent));
Steve Naroff9efdabc2007-08-03 21:21:27 +00007110}
7111
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007112//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7113// Clang Extensions.
7114//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7115
7116/// ActOnBlockStart - This callback is invoked when a block literal is started.
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007117void Sema::ActOnBlockStart(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Scope *BlockScope) {
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007118 BlockDecl *Block = BlockDecl::Create(Context, CurContext, CaretLoc);
7119 PushBlockScope(BlockScope, Block);
7120 CurContext->addDecl(Block);
Fariborz Jahanian1babe772010-07-09 18:44:02 +00007121 if (BlockScope)
7122 PushDeclContext(BlockScope, Block);
7123 else
7124 CurContext = Block;
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007125}
7126
Mike Stump82f071f2009-02-04 22:31:32 +00007127void Sema::ActOnBlockArguments(Declarator &ParamInfo, Scope *CurScope) {
Mike Stumpf70bcf72009-05-07 18:43:07 +00007128 assert(ParamInfo.getIdentifier()==0 && "block-id should have no identifier!");
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007129 BlockScopeInfo *CurBlock = getCurBlock();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007130
John McCall8cb7bdf2010-06-04 23:28:52 +00007131 TypeSourceInfo *Sig = GetTypeForDeclarator(ParamInfo, CurScope);
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007132 CurBlock->TheDecl->setSignatureAsWritten(Sig);
John McCall8cb7bdf2010-06-04 23:28:52 +00007133 QualType T = Sig->getType();
Mike Stump82f071f2009-02-04 22:31:32 +00007134
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007135 bool isVariadic;
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007136 QualType RetTy;
7137 if (const FunctionType *Fn = T->getAs<FunctionType>()) {
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007138 CurBlock->FunctionType = T;
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007139 RetTy = Fn->getResultType();
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007140 isVariadic =
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007141 !isa<FunctionProtoType>(Fn) || cast<FunctionProtoType>(Fn)->isVariadic();
7142 } else {
7143 RetTy = T;
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007144 isVariadic = false;
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007145 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007146
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007147 CurBlock->TheDecl->setIsVariadic(isVariadic);
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00007148
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007149 // Don't allow returning an array by value.
7150 if (RetTy->isArrayType()) {
7151 Diag(ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(), diag::err_block_returns_array);
Mike Stump82f071f2009-02-04 22:31:32 +00007152 return;
7153 }
7154
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007155 // Don't allow returning a objc interface by value.
7156 if (RetTy->isObjCObjectType()) {
7157 Diag(ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(),
7158 diag::err_object_cannot_be_passed_returned_by_value) << 0 << RetTy;
7159 return;
7160 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007161
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007162 // Context.DependentTy is used as a placeholder for a missing block
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007163 // return type. TODO: what should we do with declarators like:
7164 // ^ * { ... }
7165 // If the answer is "apply template argument deduction"....
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007166 if (RetTy != Context.DependentTy)
7167 CurBlock->ReturnType = RetTy;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007168
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007169 // Push block parameters from the declarator if we had them.
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007170 llvm::SmallVector<ParmVarDecl*, 8> Params;
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007171 if (isa<FunctionProtoType>(T)) {
7172 FunctionProtoTypeLoc TL = cast<FunctionProtoTypeLoc>(Sig->getTypeLoc());
7173 for (unsigned I = 0, E = TL.getNumArgs(); I != E; ++I) {
7174 ParmVarDecl *Param = TL.getArg(I);
Fariborz Jahanian5ec502e2010-02-12 21:53:14 +00007175 if (Param->getIdentifier() == 0 &&
7176 !Param->isImplicit() &&
7177 !Param->isInvalidDecl() &&
7178 !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
7179 Diag(Param->getLocation(), diag::err_parameter_name_omitted);
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007180 Params.push_back(Param);
Fariborz Jahanian5ec502e2010-02-12 21:53:14 +00007181 }
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007182
7183 // Fake up parameter variables if we have a typedef, like
7184 // ^ fntype { ... }
7185 } else if (const FunctionProtoType *Fn = T->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
7186 for (FunctionProtoType::arg_type_iterator
7187 I = Fn->arg_type_begin(), E = Fn->arg_type_end(); I != E; ++I) {
7188 ParmVarDecl *Param =
7189 BuildParmVarDeclForTypedef(CurBlock->TheDecl,
7190 ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(),
7191 *I);
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007192 Params.push_back(Param);
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007193 }
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007194 }
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007195
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007196 // Set the parameters on the block decl.
7197 if (!Params.empty())
7198 CurBlock->TheDecl->setParams(Params.data(), Params.size());
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007199
7200 // Finally we can process decl attributes.
Douglas Gregor758a8692009-06-17 21:51:59 +00007201 ProcessDeclAttributes(CurScope, CurBlock->TheDecl, ParamInfo);
John McCalldf8b37c2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007202
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007203 if (!isVariadic && CurBlock->TheDecl->getAttr<SentinelAttr>()) {
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007204 Diag(ParamInfo.getAttributes()->getLoc(),
7205 diag::warn_attribute_sentinel_not_variadic) << 1;
7206 // FIXME: remove the attribute.
7207 }
7208
7209 // Put the parameter variables in scope. We can bail out immediately
7210 // if we don't have any.
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007211 if (Params.empty())
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007212 return;
7213
John McCalldf8b37c2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007214 bool ShouldCheckShadow =
7215 Diags.getDiagnosticLevel(diag::warn_decl_shadow) != Diagnostic::Ignored;
7216
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007217 for (BlockDecl::param_iterator AI = CurBlock->TheDecl->param_begin(),
John McCallf7b2fb52010-01-22 00:28:27 +00007218 E = CurBlock->TheDecl->param_end(); AI != E; ++AI) {
7219 (*AI)->setOwningFunction(CurBlock->TheDecl);
7220
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007221 // If this has an identifier, add it to the scope stack.
John McCalldf8b37c2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007222 if ((*AI)->getIdentifier()) {
7223 if (ShouldCheckShadow)
7224 CheckShadow(CurBlock->TheScope, *AI);
7225
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007226 PushOnScopeChains(*AI, CurBlock->TheScope);
John McCalldf8b37c2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007227 }
John McCallf7b2fb52010-01-22 00:28:27 +00007228 }
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007229}
7230
7231/// ActOnBlockError - If there is an error parsing a block, this callback
7232/// is invoked to pop the information about the block from the action impl.
7233void Sema::ActOnBlockError(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Scope *CurScope) {
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007234 // Pop off CurBlock, handle nested blocks.
Chris Lattner41b86942009-04-21 22:38:46 +00007235 PopDeclContext();
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007236 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007237 // FIXME: Delete the ParmVarDecl objects as well???
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007238}
7239
7240/// ActOnBlockStmtExpr - This is called when the body of a block statement
7241/// literal was successfully completed. ^(int x){...}
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007242ExprResult Sema::ActOnBlockStmtExpr(SourceLocation CaretLoc,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007243 Stmt *Body, Scope *CurScope) {
Chris Lattner9eac9312009-03-27 04:18:06 +00007244 // If blocks are disabled, emit an error.
7245 if (!LangOpts.Blocks)
7246 Diag(CaretLoc, diag::err_blocks_disable);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007247
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007248 BlockScopeInfo *BSI = cast<BlockScopeInfo>(FunctionScopes.back());
Fariborz Jahanian1babe772010-07-09 18:44:02 +00007249
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007250 PopDeclContext();
7251
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007252 QualType RetTy = Context.VoidTy;
Fariborz Jahanian3fd73102009-06-19 23:37:08 +00007253 if (!BSI->ReturnType.isNull())
7254 RetTy = BSI->ReturnType;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007255
Mike Stump3bf1ab42009-07-28 22:04:01 +00007256 bool NoReturn = BSI->TheDecl->getAttr<NoReturnAttr>();
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007257 QualType BlockTy;
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007258
7259 // If the user wrote a function type in some form, try to use that.
7260 if (!BSI->FunctionType.isNull()) {
7261 const FunctionType *FTy = BSI->FunctionType->getAs<FunctionType>();
7262
7263 FunctionType::ExtInfo Ext = FTy->getExtInfo();
7264 if (NoReturn && !Ext.getNoReturn()) Ext = Ext.withNoReturn(true);
7265
7266 // Turn protoless block types into nullary block types.
7267 if (isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(FTy)) {
7268 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy, 0, 0, false, 0,
7269 false, false, 0, 0, Ext);
7270
7271 // Otherwise, if we don't need to change anything about the function type,
7272 // preserve its sugar structure.
7273 } else if (FTy->getResultType() == RetTy &&
7274 (!NoReturn || FTy->getNoReturnAttr())) {
7275 BlockTy = BSI->FunctionType;
7276
7277 // Otherwise, make the minimal modifications to the function type.
7278 } else {
7279 const FunctionProtoType *FPT = cast<FunctionProtoType>(FTy);
7280 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy,
7281 FPT->arg_type_begin(),
7282 FPT->getNumArgs(),
7283 FPT->isVariadic(),
7284 /*quals*/ 0,
7285 FPT->hasExceptionSpec(),
7286 FPT->hasAnyExceptionSpec(),
7287 FPT->getNumExceptions(),
7288 FPT->exception_begin(),
7289 Ext);
7290 }
7291
7292 // If we don't have a function type, just build one from nothing.
7293 } else {
7294 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy, 0, 0, false, 0,
7295 false, false, 0, 0,
7296 FunctionType::ExtInfo(NoReturn, 0, CC_Default));
7297 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007298
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00007299 // FIXME: Check that return/parameter types are complete/non-abstract
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007300 DiagnoseUnusedParameters(BSI->TheDecl->param_begin(),
7301 BSI->TheDecl->param_end());
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007302 BlockTy = Context.getBlockPointerType(BlockTy);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007303
Chris Lattner45542ea2009-04-19 05:28:12 +00007304 // If needed, diagnose invalid gotos and switches in the block.
John McCallaab3e412010-08-25 08:40:02 +00007305 if (getCurFunction()->NeedsScopeChecking() && !hasAnyErrorsInThisFunction())
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007306 DiagnoseInvalidJumps(cast<CompoundStmt>(Body));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007307
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007308 BSI->TheDecl->setBody(cast<CompoundStmt>(Body));
Mike Stump314825b2010-01-19 23:08:01 +00007309
7310 bool Good = true;
7311 // Check goto/label use.
7312 for (llvm::DenseMap<IdentifierInfo*, LabelStmt*>::iterator
7313 I = BSI->LabelMap.begin(), E = BSI->LabelMap.end(); I != E; ++I) {
7314 LabelStmt *L = I->second;
7315
7316 // Verify that we have no forward references left. If so, there was a goto
7317 // or address of a label taken, but no definition of it.
7318 if (L->getSubStmt() != 0)
7319 continue;
7320
7321 // Emit error.
7322 Diag(L->getIdentLoc(), diag::err_undeclared_label_use) << L->getName();
7323 Good = false;
7324 }
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007325 if (!Good) {
7326 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Mike Stump314825b2010-01-19 23:08:01 +00007327 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007328 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007329
John McCall1d570a72010-08-25 05:56:39 +00007330 BlockExpr *Result = new (Context) BlockExpr(BSI->TheDecl, BlockTy,
7331 BSI->hasBlockDeclRefExprs);
7332
Ted Kremenek918fe842010-03-20 21:06:02 +00007333 // Issue any analysis-based warnings.
Ted Kremenek0b405322010-03-23 00:13:23 +00007334 const sema::AnalysisBasedWarnings::Policy &WP =
7335 AnalysisWarnings.getDefaultPolicy();
John McCall1d570a72010-08-25 05:56:39 +00007336 AnalysisWarnings.IssueWarnings(WP, Result);
Ted Kremenek918fe842010-03-20 21:06:02 +00007337
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007338 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007339 return Owned(Result);
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007340}
7341
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007342ExprResult Sema::ActOnVAArg(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
John McCallba7bf592010-08-24 05:47:05 +00007343 Expr *expr, ParsedType type,
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007344 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Abramo Bagnara27db2392010-08-10 10:06:15 +00007345 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
7346 QualType T = GetTypeFromParser(type, &TInfo);
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007347 return BuildVAArgExpr(BuiltinLoc, expr, TInfo, RPLoc);
Abramo Bagnara27db2392010-08-10 10:06:15 +00007348}
7349
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007350ExprResult Sema::BuildVAArgExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007351 Expr *E, TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
Abramo Bagnara27db2392010-08-10 10:06:15 +00007352 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Chris Lattner56382aa2009-04-05 15:49:53 +00007353 Expr *OrigExpr = E;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007354
Anders Carlsson7e13ab82007-10-15 20:28:48 +00007355 InitBuiltinVaListType();
Eli Friedman121ba0c2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00007356
7357 // Get the va_list type
7358 QualType VaListType = Context.getBuiltinVaListType();
Eli Friedmane2cad652009-05-16 12:46:54 +00007359 if (VaListType->isArrayType()) {
7360 // Deal with implicit array decay; for example, on x86-64,
7361 // va_list is an array, but it's supposed to decay to
7362 // a pointer for va_arg.
Eli Friedman121ba0c2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00007363 VaListType = Context.getArrayDecayedType(VaListType);
Eli Friedmane2cad652009-05-16 12:46:54 +00007364 // Make sure the input expression also decays appropriately.
7365 UsualUnaryConversions(E);
7366 } else {
7367 // Otherwise, the va_list argument must be an l-value because
7368 // it is modified by va_arg.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007369 if (!E->isTypeDependent() &&
Douglas Gregorad3150c2009-05-19 23:10:31 +00007370 CheckForModifiableLvalue(E, BuiltinLoc, *this))
Eli Friedmane2cad652009-05-16 12:46:54 +00007371 return ExprError();
7372 }
Eli Friedman121ba0c2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00007373
Douglas Gregorad3150c2009-05-19 23:10:31 +00007374 if (!E->isTypeDependent() &&
7375 !Context.hasSameType(VaListType, E->getType())) {
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007376 return ExprError(Diag(E->getLocStart(),
7377 diag::err_first_argument_to_va_arg_not_of_type_va_list)
Chris Lattner56382aa2009-04-05 15:49:53 +00007378 << OrigExpr->getType() << E->getSourceRange());
Chris Lattner3f5cd772009-04-05 00:59:53 +00007379 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007380
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00007381 // FIXME: Check that type is complete/non-abstract
Anders Carlsson7e13ab82007-10-15 20:28:48 +00007382 // FIXME: Warn if a non-POD type is passed in.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007383
Abramo Bagnara27db2392010-08-10 10:06:15 +00007384 QualType T = TInfo->getType().getNonLValueExprType(Context);
7385 return Owned(new (Context) VAArgExpr(BuiltinLoc, E, TInfo, RPLoc, T));
Anders Carlsson7e13ab82007-10-15 20:28:48 +00007386}
7387
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007388ExprResult Sema::ActOnGNUNullExpr(SourceLocation TokenLoc) {
Douglas Gregor3be4b122008-11-29 04:51:27 +00007389 // The type of __null will be int or long, depending on the size of
7390 // pointers on the target.
7391 QualType Ty;
7392 if (Context.Target.getPointerWidth(0) == Context.Target.getIntWidth())
7393 Ty = Context.IntTy;
7394 else
7395 Ty = Context.LongTy;
7396
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007397 return Owned(new (Context) GNUNullExpr(Ty, TokenLoc));
Douglas Gregor3be4b122008-11-29 04:51:27 +00007398}
7399
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007400static void MakeObjCStringLiteralFixItHint(Sema& SemaRef, QualType DstType,
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007401 Expr *SrcExpr, FixItHint &Hint) {
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007402 if (!SemaRef.getLangOptions().ObjC1)
7403 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007404
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007405 const ObjCObjectPointerType *PT = DstType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
7406 if (!PT)
7407 return;
7408
7409 // Check if the destination is of type 'id'.
7410 if (!PT->isObjCIdType()) {
7411 // Check if the destination is the 'NSString' interface.
7412 const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ID = PT->getInterfaceDecl();
7413 if (!ID || !ID->getIdentifier()->isStr("NSString"))
7414 return;
7415 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007416
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007417 // Strip off any parens and casts.
7418 StringLiteral *SL = dyn_cast<StringLiteral>(SrcExpr->IgnoreParenCasts());
7419 if (!SL || SL->isWide())
7420 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007421
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007422 Hint = FixItHint::CreateInsertion(SL->getLocStart(), "@");
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007423}
7424
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007425bool Sema::DiagnoseAssignmentResult(AssignConvertType ConvTy,
7426 SourceLocation Loc,
7427 QualType DstType, QualType SrcType,
Douglas Gregor4f4946a2010-04-22 00:20:18 +00007428 Expr *SrcExpr, AssignmentAction Action,
7429 bool *Complained) {
7430 if (Complained)
7431 *Complained = false;
7432
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007433 // Decode the result (notice that AST's are still created for extensions).
7434 bool isInvalid = false;
7435 unsigned DiagKind;
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007436 FixItHint Hint;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007437
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007438 switch (ConvTy) {
7439 default: assert(0 && "Unknown conversion type");
7440 case Compatible: return false;
Chris Lattner940cfeb2008-01-04 18:22:42 +00007441 case PointerToInt:
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007442 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_pointer_int;
7443 break;
Chris Lattner940cfeb2008-01-04 18:22:42 +00007444 case IntToPointer:
7445 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_int_pointer;
7446 break;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007447 case IncompatiblePointer:
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007448 MakeObjCStringLiteralFixItHint(*this, DstType, SrcExpr, Hint);
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007449 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_incompatible_pointer;
7450 break;
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00007451 case IncompatiblePointerSign:
7452 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_incompatible_pointer_sign;
7453 break;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007454 case FunctionVoidPointer:
7455 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_pointer_void_func;
7456 break;
7457 case CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers:
Douglas Gregoraa1e21d2008-09-12 00:47:35 +00007458 // If the qualifiers lost were because we were applying the
7459 // (deprecated) C++ conversion from a string literal to a char*
7460 // (or wchar_t*), then there was no error (C++ 4.2p2). FIXME:
7461 // Ideally, this check would be performed in
7462 // CheckPointerTypesForAssignment. However, that would require a
7463 // bit of refactoring (so that the second argument is an
7464 // expression, rather than a type), which should be done as part
7465 // of a larger effort to fix CheckPointerTypesForAssignment for
7466 // C++ semantics.
7467 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
7468 IsStringLiteralToNonConstPointerConversion(SrcExpr, DstType))
7469 return false;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007470 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_discards_qualifiers;
7471 break;
Alexis Hunt6f3de502009-11-08 07:46:34 +00007472 case IncompatibleNestedPointerQualifiers:
Fariborz Jahanianb98dade2009-11-09 22:16:37 +00007473 DiagKind = diag::ext_nested_pointer_qualifier_mismatch;
Fariborz Jahaniand7aa9d82009-11-07 20:20:40 +00007474 break;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00007475 case IntToBlockPointer:
7476 DiagKind = diag::err_int_to_block_pointer;
7477 break;
7478 case IncompatibleBlockPointer:
Mike Stumpd79b5a82009-04-21 22:51:42 +00007479 DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_convert_incompatible_block_pointer;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00007480 break;
Steve Naroff8afa9892008-10-14 22:18:38 +00007481 case IncompatibleObjCQualifiedId:
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007482 // FIXME: Diagnose the problem in ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible, since
Steve Naroff8afa9892008-10-14 22:18:38 +00007483 // it can give a more specific diagnostic.
7484 DiagKind = diag::warn_incompatible_qualified_id;
7485 break;
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00007486 case IncompatibleVectors:
7487 DiagKind = diag::warn_incompatible_vectors;
7488 break;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007489 case Incompatible:
7490 DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_convert_incompatible;
7491 isInvalid = true;
7492 break;
7493 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007494
Douglas Gregorc68e1402010-04-09 00:35:39 +00007495 QualType FirstType, SecondType;
7496 switch (Action) {
7497 case AA_Assigning:
7498 case AA_Initializing:
7499 // The destination type comes first.
7500 FirstType = DstType;
7501 SecondType = SrcType;
7502 break;
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007503
Douglas Gregorc68e1402010-04-09 00:35:39 +00007504 case AA_Returning:
7505 case AA_Passing:
7506 case AA_Converting:
7507 case AA_Sending:
7508 case AA_Casting:
7509 // The source type comes first.
7510 FirstType = SrcType;
7511 SecondType = DstType;
7512 break;
7513 }
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007514
Douglas Gregorc68e1402010-04-09 00:35:39 +00007515 Diag(Loc, DiagKind) << FirstType << SecondType << Action
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007516 << SrcExpr->getSourceRange() << Hint;
Douglas Gregor4f4946a2010-04-22 00:20:18 +00007517 if (Complained)
7518 *Complained = true;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007519 return isInvalid;
7520}
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007521
Chris Lattnerc71d08b2009-04-25 21:59:05 +00007522bool Sema::VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(const Expr *E, llvm::APSInt *Result){
Eli Friedmanbb967cc2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00007523 llvm::APSInt ICEResult;
7524 if (E->isIntegerConstantExpr(ICEResult, Context)) {
7525 if (Result)
7526 *Result = ICEResult;
7527 return false;
7528 }
7529
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007530 Expr::EvalResult EvalResult;
7531
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007532 if (!E->Evaluate(EvalResult, Context) || !EvalResult.Val.isInt() ||
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007533 EvalResult.HasSideEffects) {
7534 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_expr_not_ice) << E->getSourceRange();
7535
7536 if (EvalResult.Diag) {
7537 // We only show the note if it's not the usual "invalid subexpression"
7538 // or if it's actually in a subexpression.
7539 if (EvalResult.Diag != diag::note_invalid_subexpr_in_ice ||
7540 E->IgnoreParens() != EvalResult.DiagExpr->IgnoreParens())
7541 Diag(EvalResult.DiagLoc, EvalResult.Diag);
7542 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007543
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007544 return true;
7545 }
7546
Eli Friedmanbb967cc2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00007547 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::ext_expr_not_ice) <<
7548 E->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007549
Eli Friedmanbb967cc2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00007550 if (EvalResult.Diag &&
7551 Diags.getDiagnosticLevel(diag::ext_expr_not_ice) != Diagnostic::Ignored)
7552 Diag(EvalResult.DiagLoc, EvalResult.Diag);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007553
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007554 if (Result)
7555 *Result = EvalResult.Val.getInt();
7556 return false;
7557}
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007558
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007559void
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007560Sema::PushExpressionEvaluationContext(ExpressionEvaluationContext NewContext) {
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007561 ExprEvalContexts.push_back(
7562 ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord(NewContext, ExprTemporaries.size()));
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007563}
7564
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007565void
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007566Sema::PopExpressionEvaluationContext() {
7567 // Pop the current expression evaluation context off the stack.
7568 ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord Rec = ExprEvalContexts.back();
7569 ExprEvalContexts.pop_back();
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007570
Douglas Gregorfab31f42009-12-12 07:57:52 +00007571 if (Rec.Context == PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated) {
7572 if (Rec.PotentiallyReferenced) {
7573 // Mark any remaining declarations in the current position of the stack
7574 // as "referenced". If they were not meant to be referenced, semantic
7575 // analysis would have eliminated them (e.g., in ActOnCXXTypeId).
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007576 for (PotentiallyReferencedDecls::iterator
Douglas Gregorfab31f42009-12-12 07:57:52 +00007577 I = Rec.PotentiallyReferenced->begin(),
7578 IEnd = Rec.PotentiallyReferenced->end();
7579 I != IEnd; ++I)
7580 MarkDeclarationReferenced(I->first, I->second);
7581 }
7582
7583 if (Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed) {
7584 // Emit any pending diagnostics.
7585 for (PotentiallyEmittedDiagnostics::iterator
7586 I = Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed->begin(),
7587 IEnd = Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed->end();
7588 I != IEnd; ++I)
7589 Diag(I->first, I->second);
7590 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007591 }
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007592
7593 // When are coming out of an unevaluated context, clear out any
7594 // temporaries that we may have created as part of the evaluation of
7595 // the expression in that context: they aren't relevant because they
7596 // will never be constructed.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007597 if (Rec.Context == Unevaluated &&
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007598 ExprTemporaries.size() > Rec.NumTemporaries)
7599 ExprTemporaries.erase(ExprTemporaries.begin() + Rec.NumTemporaries,
7600 ExprTemporaries.end());
7601
7602 // Destroy the popped expression evaluation record.
7603 Rec.Destroy();
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007604}
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007605
7606/// \brief Note that the given declaration was referenced in the source code.
7607///
7608/// This routine should be invoke whenever a given declaration is referenced
7609/// in the source code, and where that reference occurred. If this declaration
7610/// reference means that the the declaration is used (C++ [basic.def.odr]p2,
7611/// C99 6.9p3), then the declaration will be marked as used.
7612///
7613/// \param Loc the location where the declaration was referenced.
7614///
7615/// \param D the declaration that has been referenced by the source code.
7616void Sema::MarkDeclarationReferenced(SourceLocation Loc, Decl *D) {
7617 assert(D && "No declaration?");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007618
Douglas Gregorebada0772010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007619 if (D->isUsed(false))
Douglas Gregor77b50e12009-06-22 23:06:13 +00007620 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007621
Douglas Gregor3beaf9b2009-10-08 21:35:42 +00007622 // Mark a parameter or variable declaration "used", regardless of whether we're in a
7623 // template or not. The reason for this is that unevaluated expressions
7624 // (e.g. (void)sizeof()) constitute a use for warning purposes (-Wunused-variables and
7625 // -Wunused-parameters)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007626 if (isa<ParmVarDecl>(D) ||
Douglas Gregorfd27fed2010-04-07 20:29:57 +00007627 (isa<VarDecl>(D) && D->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod())) {
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007628 D->setUsed(true);
Douglas Gregorfd27fed2010-04-07 20:29:57 +00007629 return;
7630 }
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007631
Douglas Gregorfd27fed2010-04-07 20:29:57 +00007632 if (!isa<VarDecl>(D) && !isa<FunctionDecl>(D))
7633 return;
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007634
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007635 // Do not mark anything as "used" within a dependent context; wait for
7636 // an instantiation.
7637 if (CurContext->isDependentContext())
7638 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007639
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007640 switch (ExprEvalContexts.back().Context) {
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007641 case Unevaluated:
7642 // We are in an expression that is not potentially evaluated; do nothing.
7643 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007644
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007645 case PotentiallyEvaluated:
7646 // We are in a potentially-evaluated expression, so this declaration is
7647 // "used"; handle this below.
7648 break;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007649
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007650 case PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated:
7651 // We are in an expression that may be potentially evaluated; queue this
7652 // declaration reference until we know whether the expression is
7653 // potentially evaluated.
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007654 ExprEvalContexts.back().addReferencedDecl(Loc, D);
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007655 return;
7656 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007657
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007658 // Note that this declaration has been used.
Fariborz Jahanian3a363432009-06-22 17:30:33 +00007659 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahanian477d2422009-06-22 23:34:40 +00007660 unsigned TypeQuals;
Fariborz Jahanian18eb69a2009-06-22 20:37:23 +00007661 if (Constructor->isImplicit() && Constructor->isDefaultConstructor()) {
Chandler Carruthc9262402010-08-23 07:55:51 +00007662 if (Constructor->getParent()->hasTrivialConstructor())
7663 return;
7664 if (!Constructor->isUsed(false))
7665 DefineImplicitDefaultConstructor(Loc, Constructor);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007666 } else if (Constructor->isImplicit() &&
Douglas Gregor507eb872009-12-22 00:34:07 +00007667 Constructor->isCopyConstructor(TypeQuals)) {
Douglas Gregorebada0772010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007668 if (!Constructor->isUsed(false))
Fariborz Jahanian477d2422009-06-22 23:34:40 +00007669 DefineImplicitCopyConstructor(Loc, Constructor, TypeQuals);
7670 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007671
Douglas Gregor88d292c2010-05-13 16:44:06 +00007672 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, Constructor->getParent());
Fariborz Jahanian24a175b2009-06-26 23:49:16 +00007673 } else if (CXXDestructorDecl *Destructor = dyn_cast<CXXDestructorDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregorebada0772010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007674 if (Destructor->isImplicit() && !Destructor->isUsed(false))
Fariborz Jahanian24a175b2009-06-26 23:49:16 +00007675 DefineImplicitDestructor(Loc, Destructor);
Douglas Gregor88d292c2010-05-13 16:44:06 +00007676 if (Destructor->isVirtual())
7677 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, Destructor->getParent());
Fariborz Jahanian41f79272009-06-25 21:45:19 +00007678 } else if (CXXMethodDecl *MethodDecl = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(D)) {
7679 if (MethodDecl->isImplicit() && MethodDecl->isOverloadedOperator() &&
7680 MethodDecl->getOverloadedOperator() == OO_Equal) {
Douglas Gregorebada0772010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007681 if (!MethodDecl->isUsed(false))
Douglas Gregora57478e2010-05-01 15:04:51 +00007682 DefineImplicitCopyAssignment(Loc, MethodDecl);
Douglas Gregor88d292c2010-05-13 16:44:06 +00007683 } else if (MethodDecl->isVirtual())
7684 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, MethodDecl->getParent());
Fariborz Jahanian41f79272009-06-25 21:45:19 +00007685 }
Fariborz Jahanian49796cc72009-06-24 22:09:44 +00007686 if (FunctionDecl *Function = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007687 // Implicit instantiation of function templates and member functions of
Douglas Gregor4adbc6d2009-06-26 00:10:03 +00007688 // class templates.
Douglas Gregor69f6a362010-05-17 17:34:56 +00007689 if (Function->isImplicitlyInstantiable()) {
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007690 bool AlreadyInstantiated = false;
7691 if (FunctionTemplateSpecializationInfo *SpecInfo
7692 = Function->getTemplateSpecializationInfo()) {
7693 if (SpecInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid())
7694 SpecInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007695 else if (SpecInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()
Douglas Gregorafca3b42009-10-27 20:53:28 +00007696 == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007697 AlreadyInstantiated = true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007698 } else if (MemberSpecializationInfo *MSInfo
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007699 = Function->getMemberSpecializationInfo()) {
7700 if (MSInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid())
7701 MSInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007702 else if (MSInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()
Douglas Gregorafca3b42009-10-27 20:53:28 +00007703 == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007704 AlreadyInstantiated = true;
7705 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007706
Douglas Gregor7f792cf2010-01-16 22:29:39 +00007707 if (!AlreadyInstantiated) {
7708 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(Function->getDeclContext()) &&
7709 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Function->getDeclContext())->isLocalClass())
7710 PendingLocalImplicitInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Function,
7711 Loc));
7712 else
Chandler Carruth54080172010-08-25 08:44:16 +00007713 PendingInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Function, Loc));
Douglas Gregor7f792cf2010-01-16 22:29:39 +00007714 }
Gabor Greifb6aba3e2010-08-28 00:16:06 +00007715 } else // Walk redefinitions, as some of them may be instantiable.
7716 for (FunctionDecl::redecl_iterator i(Function->redecls_begin()),
7717 e(Function->redecls_end()); i != e; ++i) {
Gabor Greif34ecff22010-08-28 01:58:12 +00007718 if (!i->isUsed(false) && i->isImplicitlyInstantiable())
Gabor Greifb6aba3e2010-08-28 00:16:06 +00007719 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, *i);
7720 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007721
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007722 // FIXME: keep track of references to static functions
Argyrios Kyrtzidisdfffabd2010-08-25 10:34:54 +00007723
7724 // Recursive functions should be marked when used from another function.
7725 if (CurContext != Function)
7726 Function->setUsed(true);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007727
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007728 return;
Douglas Gregor77b50e12009-06-22 23:06:13 +00007729 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007730
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007731 if (VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00007732 // Implicit instantiation of static data members of class templates.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007733 if (Var->isStaticDataMember() &&
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007734 Var->getInstantiatedFromStaticDataMember()) {
7735 MemberSpecializationInfo *MSInfo = Var->getMemberSpecializationInfo();
7736 assert(MSInfo && "Missing member specialization information?");
7737 if (MSInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid() &&
7738 MSInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()== TSK_ImplicitInstantiation) {
7739 MSInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
Chandler Carruth54080172010-08-25 08:44:16 +00007740 PendingInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Var, Loc));
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007741 }
7742 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007743
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007744 // FIXME: keep track of references to static data?
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00007745
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007746 D->setUsed(true);
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00007747 return;
Sam Weinigbae69142009-09-11 03:29:30 +00007748 }
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007749}
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007750
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007751namespace {
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007752 // Mark all of the declarations referenced
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007753 // FIXME: Not fully implemented yet! We need to have a better understanding
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007754 // of when we're entering
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007755 class MarkReferencedDecls : public RecursiveASTVisitor<MarkReferencedDecls> {
7756 Sema &S;
7757 SourceLocation Loc;
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007758
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007759 public:
7760 typedef RecursiveASTVisitor<MarkReferencedDecls> Inherited;
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007761
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007762 MarkReferencedDecls(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc) : S(S), Loc(Loc) { }
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007763
7764 bool TraverseTemplateArgument(const TemplateArgument &Arg);
7765 bool TraverseRecordType(RecordType *T);
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007766 };
7767}
7768
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007769bool MarkReferencedDecls::TraverseTemplateArgument(
7770 const TemplateArgument &Arg) {
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007771 if (Arg.getKind() == TemplateArgument::Declaration) {
7772 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, Arg.getAsDecl());
7773 }
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007774
7775 return Inherited::TraverseTemplateArgument(Arg);
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007776}
7777
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007778bool MarkReferencedDecls::TraverseRecordType(RecordType *T) {
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007779 if (ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl *Spec
7780 = dyn_cast<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(T->getDecl())) {
7781 const TemplateArgumentList &Args = Spec->getTemplateArgs();
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007782 return TraverseTemplateArguments(Args.getFlatArgumentList(),
7783 Args.flat_size());
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007784 }
7785
Chandler Carruthc65667c2010-06-10 10:31:57 +00007786 return true;
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007787}
7788
7789void Sema::MarkDeclarationsReferencedInType(SourceLocation Loc, QualType T) {
7790 MarkReferencedDecls Marker(*this, Loc);
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007791 Marker.TraverseType(Context.getCanonicalType(T));
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007792}
7793
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007794/// \brief Emit a diagnostic that describes an effect on the run-time behavior
7795/// of the program being compiled.
7796///
7797/// This routine emits the given diagnostic when the code currently being
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007798/// type-checked is "potentially evaluated", meaning that there is a
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007799/// possibility that the code will actually be executable. Code in sizeof()
7800/// expressions, code used only during overload resolution, etc., are not
7801/// potentially evaluated. This routine will suppress such diagnostics or,
7802/// in the absolutely nutty case of potentially potentially evaluated
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007803/// expressions (C++ typeid), queue the diagnostic to potentially emit it
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007804/// later.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007805///
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007806/// This routine should be used for all diagnostics that describe the run-time
7807/// behavior of a program, such as passing a non-POD value through an ellipsis.
7808/// Failure to do so will likely result in spurious diagnostics or failures
7809/// during overload resolution or within sizeof/alignof/typeof/typeid.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007810bool Sema::DiagRuntimeBehavior(SourceLocation Loc,
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007811 const PartialDiagnostic &PD) {
7812 switch (ExprEvalContexts.back().Context ) {
7813 case Unevaluated:
7814 // The argument will never be evaluated, so don't complain.
7815 break;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007816
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007817 case PotentiallyEvaluated:
7818 Diag(Loc, PD);
7819 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007820
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007821 case PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated:
7822 ExprEvalContexts.back().addDiagnostic(Loc, PD);
7823 break;
7824 }
7825
7826 return false;
7827}
7828
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007829bool Sema::CheckCallReturnType(QualType ReturnType, SourceLocation Loc,
7830 CallExpr *CE, FunctionDecl *FD) {
7831 if (ReturnType->isVoidType() || !ReturnType->isIncompleteType())
7832 return false;
7833
7834 PartialDiagnostic Note =
7835 FD ? PDiag(diag::note_function_with_incomplete_return_type_declared_here)
7836 << FD->getDeclName() : PDiag();
7837 SourceLocation NoteLoc = FD ? FD->getLocation() : SourceLocation();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007838
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007839 if (RequireCompleteType(Loc, ReturnType,
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007840 FD ?
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007841 PDiag(diag::err_call_function_incomplete_return)
7842 << CE->getSourceRange() << FD->getDeclName() :
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007843 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_return)
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007844 << CE->getSourceRange(),
7845 std::make_pair(NoteLoc, Note)))
7846 return true;
7847
7848 return false;
7849}
7850
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007851// Diagnose the common s/=/==/ typo. Note that adding parentheses
7852// will prevent this condition from triggering, which is what we want.
7853void Sema::DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition(Expr *E) {
7854 SourceLocation Loc;
7855
John McCall0506e4a2009-11-11 02:41:58 +00007856 unsigned diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_assignment;
7857
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007858 if (isa<BinaryOperator>(E)) {
7859 BinaryOperator *Op = cast<BinaryOperator>(E);
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007860 if (Op->getOpcode() != BO_Assign)
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007861 return;
7862
John McCallb0e419e2009-11-12 00:06:05 +00007863 // Greylist some idioms by putting them into a warning subcategory.
7864 if (ObjCMessageExpr *ME
7865 = dyn_cast<ObjCMessageExpr>(Op->getRHS()->IgnoreParenCasts())) {
7866 Selector Sel = ME->getSelector();
7867
John McCallb0e419e2009-11-12 00:06:05 +00007868 // self = [<foo> init...]
7869 if (isSelfExpr(Op->getLHS())
7870 && Sel.getIdentifierInfoForSlot(0)->getName().startswith("init"))
7871 diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_idiomatic_assignment;
7872
7873 // <foo> = [<bar> nextObject]
7874 else if (Sel.isUnarySelector() &&
7875 Sel.getIdentifierInfoForSlot(0)->getName() == "nextObject")
7876 diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_idiomatic_assignment;
7877 }
John McCall0506e4a2009-11-11 02:41:58 +00007878
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007879 Loc = Op->getOperatorLoc();
7880 } else if (isa<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(E)) {
7881 CXXOperatorCallExpr *Op = cast<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(E);
7882 if (Op->getOperator() != OO_Equal)
7883 return;
7884
7885 Loc = Op->getOperatorLoc();
7886 } else {
7887 // Not an assignment.
7888 return;
7889 }
7890
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007891 SourceLocation Open = E->getSourceRange().getBegin();
John McCalle724ae92009-10-12 22:25:59 +00007892 SourceLocation Close = PP.getLocForEndOfToken(E->getSourceRange().getEnd());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007893
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00007894 Diag(Loc, diagnostic) << E->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00007895 Diag(Loc, diag::note_condition_assign_to_comparison)
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007896 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(Loc, "==");
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00007897 Diag(Loc, diag::note_condition_assign_silence)
7898 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Open, "(")
7899 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Close, ")");
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007900}
7901
7902bool Sema::CheckBooleanCondition(Expr *&E, SourceLocation Loc) {
7903 DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition(E);
7904
7905 if (!E->isTypeDependent()) {
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00007906 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(E);
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007907
7908 QualType T = E->getType();
7909
7910 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
7911 if (CheckCXXBooleanCondition(E)) // C++ 6.4p4
7912 return true;
7913 } else if (!T->isScalarType()) { // C99 6.8.4.1p1
7914 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_statement_requires_scalar)
7915 << T << E->getSourceRange();
7916 return true;
7917 }
7918 }
7919
7920 return false;
7921}
Douglas Gregore60e41a2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00007922
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007923ExprResult Sema::ActOnBooleanCondition(Scope *S, SourceLocation Loc,
7924 Expr *Sub) {
Douglas Gregor12cc7ee2010-05-06 21:39:56 +00007925 if (!Sub)
Douglas Gregore60e41a2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00007926 return ExprError();
7927
Douglas Gregorb412e172010-07-25 18:17:45 +00007928 if (CheckBooleanCondition(Sub, Loc))
Douglas Gregore60e41a2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00007929 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregore60e41a2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00007930
7931 return Owned(Sub);
7932}